blob: 8aeeb272d0aeca7477bbb634b52181121122b865 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau60612eb2011-09-10 23:43:11 +02007 2011/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200451 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100452 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200453 - noepoll
454 - nokqueue
455 - nopoll
456 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100457 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200458 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200459 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200460 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200461 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100462 - tune.maxaccept
463 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200464 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200465 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100466 - tune.rcvbuf.client
467 - tune.rcvbuf.server
468 - tune.sndbuf.client
469 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471 * Debugging
472 - debug
473 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474
475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477------------------------------------
478
479chroot <jail dir>
480 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
481 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
482 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
483 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
484 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
485 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487daemon
488 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
489 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
490 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
491
492gid <number>
493 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
494 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
495 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
496 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498group <group name>
499 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
500 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200502log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
504 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100505 configured with "log global".
506
507 <address> can be one of:
508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100509 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100510 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
511 port).
512
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100513 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
514 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
515 port).
516
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100517 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
518 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
519 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
520 writeable).
521
522 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523
524 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
525 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
526 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
527
528 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200529 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
530 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
531 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
532 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
533 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
534 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200535
536 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
537
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100538log-send-hostname [<string>]
539 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
540 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
541 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
542 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
543 the logs.
544
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000545log-tag <string>
546 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
547 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
548 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
549 running on the same host.
550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551nbproc <number>
552 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
553 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
554 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
555 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
556 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
557
558pidfile <pidfile>
559 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
560 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
561 starting the process. See also "daemon".
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200564 [level <level>]
565
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200566 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
567 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100568 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200569 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
570
571 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
572 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
573 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
574 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
575 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
576
577 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200578 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200579 counters).
580
581 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
582 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100583
584 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
585 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
586 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
587 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
588 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
589 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
590 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200591
592stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
593 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
594 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100595 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200596
597stats maxconn <connections>
598 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
599 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601uid <number>
602 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
603 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
604 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
605 one. See also "gid" and "user".
606
607ulimit-n <number>
608 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
609 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
610 option.
611
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
613 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
614
615 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
616 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
617 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
618 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
619 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
620 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
621 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
622 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
623 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
624 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626user <user name>
627 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
628 See also "uid" and "group".
629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200630node <name>
631 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
632
633 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
634 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
635 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
636 traffic.
637
638description <text>
639 Add a text that describes the instance.
640
641 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
642 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
643 "<" and ">" characters.
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006463.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647-----------------------
648
649maxconn <number>
650 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
651 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
652 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
653 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
654
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200655maxconnrate <number>
656 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
663 fairness.
664
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100665maxpipes <number>
666 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
667 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
668 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
669 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
670 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
671 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673noepoll
674 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
675 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
676 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
677
678nokqueue
679 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
680 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
681 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
682
683nopoll
684 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
685 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100686 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200687 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
688 "nokqueue".
689
690nosepoll
691 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
692 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
693 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
694
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100695nosplice
696 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
697 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
698 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100699 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100700 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
701 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
702 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
703 "option splice-response".
704
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200705spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
706 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
707 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
708 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
709 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
710 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
711
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200712tune.bufsize <number>
713 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
714 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
715 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
716 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
717 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
718 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
719 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
720 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
721
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200722tune.chksize <number>
723 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
724 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
725 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
726 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
727 checks whenever possible.
728
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200729tune.http.maxhdr <number>
730 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
731 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
732 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
733 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
734 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
735 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
736 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
737 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
738 limit too high.
739
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100740tune.maxaccept <number>
741 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
742 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
743 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100744 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100745 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
746 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100747 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100748 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
749
750tune.maxpollevents <number>
751 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
752 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
753 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
754 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
755 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
756
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200757tune.maxrewrite <number>
758 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
759 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
760 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
761 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
762 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
763 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
764 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
765 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
766 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
767 bufsize.
768
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200769tune.pipesize <number>
770 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
771 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
772 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
773 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
774 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
775 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
776
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100777tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
778tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
779 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
780 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
781 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
782 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
783 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
784 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
785 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
786
787tune.sndbuf.client <number>
788tune.sndbuf.server <number>
789 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
790 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
791 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
792 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
793 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
794 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
795 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
796 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
797 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
798 notifying haproxy again.
799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008013.3. Debugging
802--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803
804debug
805 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
806 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
807 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
808 system startup.
809
810quiet
811 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
812 line argument "-q".
813
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008153.4. Userlists
816--------------
817It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
818http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
819it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
820
821userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100822 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100823 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
824
825group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100826 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100827 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
828 proceeded by "users" keyword.
829
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100830user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
831 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100832 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
833 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100834 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
835 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100836 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
837 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
838
839
840 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100841 userlist L1
842 group G1 users tiger,scott
843 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100844
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100845 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
846 user scott insecure-password elgato
847 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100848
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100849 userlist L2
850 group G1
851 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100852
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100853 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
854 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
855 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856
857 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200858
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200859
8603.5. Peers
861--------------
862It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
863haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
864pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
865identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
866or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
867Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
868known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
869the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
870process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
871during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
872tables.
873
874peers <peersect>
875 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
876 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
877
878peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
879 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
880 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
881 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
882 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
883 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
884 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
885
886 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
887 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
888
889 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
890 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
891 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
892 across all peers.
893
894Example:
895 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100896 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
897 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
898 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200899
900 backend mybackend
901 mode tcp
902 balance roundrobin
903 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
904 stick on src
905
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100906 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
907 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200908
909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009104. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200911----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100912
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
914 - defaults <name>
915 - frontend <name>
916 - backend <name>
917 - listen <name>
918
919A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
920its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
921section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100922section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
924A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
925connections.
926
927A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
928to forward incoming connections.
929
930A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
931parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100933All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
934'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
935case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
936
937Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
938logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
939proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
940However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
941name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
942
943Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
944and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100945bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100946protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
947modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
948arbitrary criteria.
949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009514.1. Proxy keywords matrix
952--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200954The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
955limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
956they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
957limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100958marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200959option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200960and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
961with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
962specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100963
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200964
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
966------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
967acl - X X X
968appsession - - X X
969backlog X X X -
970balance X - X X
971bind - X X -
972bind-process X X X X
973block - X X X
974capture cookie - X X -
975capture request header - X X -
976capture response header - X X -
977clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
978contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
979cookie X - X X
980default-server X - X X
981default_backend X X X -
982description - X X X
983disabled X X X X
984dispatch - - X X
985enabled X X X X
986errorfile X X X X
987errorloc X X X X
988errorloc302 X X X X
989-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
990errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200991force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100992fullconn X - X X
993grace X X X X
994hash-type X - X X
995http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100996http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200997http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100998http-request - X X X
999id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001000ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001001log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002maxconn X X X -
1003mode X X X X
1004monitor fail - X X -
1005monitor-net X X X -
1006monitor-uri X X X -
1007option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1008option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1009option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1010option allbackups (*) X - X X
1011option checkcache (*) X - X X
1012option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1013option contstats (*) X X X -
1014option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1015option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1016option forceclose (*) X X X X
1017-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1018option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001019option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001020option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001021option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1022option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1023option httpchk X - X X
1024option httpclose (*) X X X X
1025option httplog X X X X
1026option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1027option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001028option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001029option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1030option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1031option logasap (*) X X X -
1032option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001033option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001034option nolinger (*) X X X X
1035option originalto X X X X
1036option persist (*) X - X X
1037option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001038option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001039option smtpchk X - X X
1040option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1041option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1042option splice-request (*) X X X X
1043option splice-response (*) X X X X
1044option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1045option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1046-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1047option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1048option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1049option tcpka X X X X
1050option tcplog X X X X
1051option transparent (*) X - X X
1052persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1053rate-limit sessions X X X -
1054redirect - X X X
1055redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1056redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1057reqadd - X X X
1058reqallow - X X X
1059reqdel - X X X
1060reqdeny - X X X
1061reqiallow - X X X
1062reqidel - X X X
1063reqideny - X X X
1064reqipass - X X X
1065reqirep - X X X
1066reqisetbe - X X X
1067reqitarpit - X X X
1068reqpass - X X X
1069reqrep - X X X
1070-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1071reqsetbe - X X X
1072reqtarpit - X X X
1073retries X - X X
1074rspadd - X X X
1075rspdel - X X X
1076rspdeny - X X X
1077rspidel - X X X
1078rspideny - X X X
1079rspirep - X X X
1080rsprep - X X X
1081server - - X X
1082source X - X X
1083srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001084stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001085stats auth X - X X
1086stats enable X - X X
1087stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001088stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001089stats realm X - X X
1090stats refresh X - X X
1091stats scope X - X X
1092stats show-desc X - X X
1093stats show-legends X - X X
1094stats show-node X - X X
1095stats uri X - X X
1096-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1097stick match - - X X
1098stick on - - X X
1099stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001100stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001101stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001102tcp-request connection - X X -
1103tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001104tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001105tcp-response content - - X X
1106tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001107timeout check X - X X
1108timeout client X X X -
1109timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1110timeout connect X - X X
1111timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1112timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1113timeout http-request X X X X
1114timeout queue X - X X
1115timeout server X - X X
1116timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1117timeout tarpit X X X X
1118transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1119use_backend - X X -
1120------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1121 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011244.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1125---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001126
1127This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1128
1129
1130acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1131 Declare or complete an access list.
1132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1133 no | yes | yes | yes
1134 Example:
1135 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1136 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1137 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001139 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140
1141
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001142appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1143 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001144 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1146 no | no | yes | yes
1147 Arguments :
1148 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1149 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1150
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001151 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001152 checked in each cookie value.
1153
1154 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1155 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1156 milliseconds.
1157
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001158 request-learn
1159 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1160 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1161 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1162 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1163 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1164 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1165
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001166 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1167 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1168 data following this prefix.
1169
1170 Example :
1171 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1172
1173 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1174 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1175
1176 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1177 2 modes are currently supported :
1178 - path-parameters :
1179 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1180 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1181 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1182 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1183 - query-string :
1184 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1185 query string.
1186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001187 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1188 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1189 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1190 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001191 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1192 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1193 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001194 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1195 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1196
1197 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1198
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001199 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1200 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1201 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 Example :
1204 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1205
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001206 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1207 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001208
1209
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001210backlog <conns>
1211 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1213 yes | yes | yes | no
1214 Arguments :
1215 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1216 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1217 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1218
1219 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1220 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1221 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1222 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1223 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1224 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1225 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1226 backlog parameter.
1227
1228 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1229 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1230 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1231
1232 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1233
1234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001235balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001236balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001237 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1239 yes | no | yes | yes
1240 Arguments :
1241 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1242 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1243 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1244 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1245
1246 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1247 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1248 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1249 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001250 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1251 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1252 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1253 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1254 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1255 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1256 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1257 it, so that you don't worry.
1258
1259 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1260 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1261 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1262 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1263 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1264 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1265 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1266 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001268 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1269 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1270 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1271 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1272 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1273 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1274 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1275 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001277 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1278 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1279 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1280 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1281 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1282 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1283 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1284 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001285 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001286 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001287 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1288 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1289 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001290
1291 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1292 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1293 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1294 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1295 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1296 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1297 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001298 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1299 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1300 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001301
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001302 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1303 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1304 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1305 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1306 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1307 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1308 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1309 URIs start with a leading "/".
1310
1311 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1312 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1313 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1314 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001316 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001317 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1318
1319 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1320 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001321 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1322 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001323 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1324 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1325 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1326 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1327 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1328 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1329 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1330 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1331 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1332 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1333 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1334 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1335 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1336 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1337 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1338 be randomly balanced if at all.
1339
1340 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1341 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1342 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1343 server will receive the request.
1344
1345 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1346 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1347 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1348 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1349 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001350 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1351 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1352 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001354 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001355 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1356 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001357 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001358 algorithm is applied instead.
1359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001360 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001361 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1362 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1363 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1364
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001365 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1366 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1367 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1368
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001369 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001370 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001371 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1372 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1373 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1374 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1375 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1376 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001378 used instead.
1379
1380 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1381 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1382 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1383 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1384
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001385 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1386 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1387 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1388
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001389 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001391 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001392 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1393 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001394
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001395 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001396 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001397
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001398 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1399 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1400 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001401
1402 Examples :
1403 balance roundrobin
1404 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001405 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001406 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1407 balance hdr(host)
1408 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001409
1410 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1411 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001413 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001414 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1415 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1416 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1417 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1418
1419 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1420 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1421 defaults to 16 kB.
1422
1423 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1424 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1425
1426 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1427 Round Robin.
1428
1429 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1430 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1431 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1432 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1433
1434 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1435
1436 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001437 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001438 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1439 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1440 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001442 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1443 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444
1445
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001446bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1447bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1448bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1449bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1450bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1451bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1452bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001453bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001454bind /<path> [, ...]
1455bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1456bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1457bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1460 no | yes | yes | no
1461 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001462 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1463 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1464 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1465 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001466 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001467
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001468 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1469 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001470 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1471 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1472 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001473 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1474 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1475 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1476 the range.
1477
1478 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1479 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1480 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1481 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1482 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1483 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1484 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1485 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1486 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001488 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1489 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1490 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1491 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1492 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1493 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1494 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1495 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1496
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001497 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1498 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1499 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1500 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1501 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1502 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1503 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1504 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001505 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1506 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001507
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001508 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1509 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1510 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1511 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1512 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1513 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001514 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1515 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1516 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1517 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1518 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1519 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1520 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1521 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001522
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001523 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1524 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1525 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1526 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001527
1528 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1529
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001530 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1531 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1532 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1533 simply ignore this.
1534
1535 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1536 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1537 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1538 simply ignore this.
1539
1540 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1541 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1542 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1543 this.
1544
1545 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1546 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1547 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1548 this.
1549
1550 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1551 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1552 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1553 this.
1554
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001555 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1556 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1557 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001558 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001559 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1560 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1561 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1562 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001563 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1564 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001566 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001567 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1568 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1569 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1570 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1571 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1572 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1573 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1574 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1575 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1576 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1577 with front firewalls which would see an established
1578 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1579
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001580 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1581 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1582 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1583 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1584 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1585 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1586 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1587 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1588 This keyword combined with support from external components
1589 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1590 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1591 not even always usable.
1592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001593 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1594 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1595 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1596 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1597 in a frontend.
1598
1599 Example :
1600 listen http_proxy
1601 bind :80,:443
1602 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001603 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001605 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001606 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607
1608
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001609bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1610 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1612 yes | yes | yes | yes
1613 Arguments :
1614 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1615 may be used to override a default value.
1616
1617 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1618 option may be combined with other numbers.
1619
1620 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1621 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1622 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1623 missing from all processes.
1624
1625 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1626 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1627 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1628 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1629
1630 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1631 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1632 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1633 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1634 and 'even' instances.
1635
1636 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1637 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1638 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1639 32.
1640
1641 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1642 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1643
1644 Example :
1645 listen app_ip1
1646 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001647 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001648
1649 listen app_ip2
1650 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001651 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001652
1653 listen management
1654 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001655 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001656
1657 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1658
1659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001660block { if | unless } <condition>
1661 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1663 no | yes | yes | yes
1664
1665 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1666 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001667 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001668 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1670 "block" statements per instance.
1671
1672 Example:
1673 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1674 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1675 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1676 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001678 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679
1680
1681capture cookie <name> len <length>
1682 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1684 no | yes | yes | no
1685 Arguments :
1686 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1687 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1688 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1689 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1690 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1691
1692 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1693 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1694 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1695 right if it exceeds <length>.
1696
1697 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1698 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1699 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1700 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1701
1702 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1703 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1704 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1705
1706 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1707 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1708 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1709 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001710 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001711 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1712
1713 Example:
1714 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1715
1716 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001717 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718
1719
1720capture request header <name> len <length>
1721 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1723 no | yes | yes | no
1724 Arguments :
1725 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001726 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1728 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1729 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1730
1731 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1732 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1733 it exceeds <length>.
1734
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001735 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1737 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001738 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1739 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1740 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1741 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001743 environments to find where the request came from.
1744
1745 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1746 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1747 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1748 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749
1750 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1751 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1752 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1753 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1754
1755 Example:
1756 capture request header Host len 15
1757 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1758 capture request header Referrer len 15
1759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001760 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 about logging.
1762
1763
1764capture response header <name> len <length>
1765 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 no | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001770 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1772 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1773 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1774
1775 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1776 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1777 it exceeds <length>.
1778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001779 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1781 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1782 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001783 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1784 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1785 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1786 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787
1788 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1789 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1790 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1791 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1792
1793 Example:
1794 capture response header Content-length len 9
1795 capture response header Location len 15
1796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001797 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 about logging.
1799
1800
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001801clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1804 yes | yes | yes | no
1805 Arguments :
1806 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1808 as explained at the top of this document.
1809
1810 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1811 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1812 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1813 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1814 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1815 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1816 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1817 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001818 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1820 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1821
1822 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1823 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1824 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1825 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1826 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1827 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1828
1829 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1830 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1831
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001832 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1833 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834
1835
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001836contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1839 yes | no | yes | yes
1840 Arguments :
1841 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1843 as explained at the top of this document.
1844
1845 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001846 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001847 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1849 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1850 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1851 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1852
1853 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1854 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1855 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1856 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1857 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1858 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1859
1860 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1861 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1862 instead.
1863
1864 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1865 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1866
1867
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001868cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001869 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001870 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1873 yes | no | yes | yes
1874 Arguments :
1875 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1876 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1877 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1878 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1879 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1880 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1881 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1882 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1883 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1884
1885 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1886 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1887 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1888 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1889 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1890 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1891 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1892 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1893 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1894 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1895 "insert" and "prefix".
1896
1897 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001898 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001899
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001900 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001901 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1902 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1903 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1904 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1905 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1906 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1907 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1908 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1909 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1910 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911
1912 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1913 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1914 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1915 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1916 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1917 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1918 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1919 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1920 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1921 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001922 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1923 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1924 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001926 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1927 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1928 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001929 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1930 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1931 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1932 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001933 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1934 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1935 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
1937 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1938 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1939 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1940 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1941 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1942 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1943 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1944 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1945 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1946
1947 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1948 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1949 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1950 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1951 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1952 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1953 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1954 persistence cookie in the cache.
1955 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1956
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001957 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1958 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1959 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1960 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1961 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1962 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1963 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1964 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1965 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1966 they logout.
1967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001968 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001969 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001970 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1971 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1972 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1973 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1974 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1975 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001976
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001977 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1978 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1979 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1980 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1981 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1982 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1983 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1984 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1985 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1986 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1987 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1988 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1989 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1990 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1991 the site.
1992
1993 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1994 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1995 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1996 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1997 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1998 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1999 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2000 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2001 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2002 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2003 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2004 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2005 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2006 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2007 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2008 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2011 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2012 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2013 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 Examples :
2016 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2017 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2018 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002019 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002021 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002022 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002025default-server [param*]
2026 Change default options for a server in a backend
2027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2028 yes | no | yes | yes
2029 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002030 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2031 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2032 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2033 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002034
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002035 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002036 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2037
2038 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041default_backend <backend>
2042 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2047
2048 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2049 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2050 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2051 will catch all undetermined requests.
2052
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053 Example :
2054
2055 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2056 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2057 default_backend dynamic
2058
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002059 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061
2062disabled
2063 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | yes
2066 Arguments : none
2067
2068 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2069 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2070 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2071 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2072 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2073 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2074 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2075
2076 See also : "enabled"
2077
2078
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002079dispatch <address>:<port>
2080 Set a default server address
2081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2082 no | no | yes | yes
2083 Arguments : none
2084
2085 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2086 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2087 during start-up.
2088
2089 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2090 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2091 possible with normal servers.
2092
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002093 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002094 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2095 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2096 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2097 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2098
2099 See also : "server"
2100
2101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102enabled
2103 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2105 yes | yes | yes | yes
2106 Arguments : none
2107
2108 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2109 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2110
2111 See also : "disabled"
2112
2113
2114errorfile <code> <file>
2115 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2117 yes | yes | yes | yes
2118 Arguments :
2119 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002120 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121
2122 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002123 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002125 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2126 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
2128 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2129 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2130 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2131
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002132 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2135 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2136 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2137 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2138
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002139 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2140 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2141 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2142 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2143 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2144 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2147 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2148 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002149 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2151
2152 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2153
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002154 Example :
2155 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2156 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2157 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2158
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002159
2160errorloc <code> <url>
2161errorloc302 <code> <url>
2162 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2164 yes | yes | yes | yes
2165 Arguments :
2166 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002167 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002168
2169 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2170 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2171 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2172 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2173 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2174
2175 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2176 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2177 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2178
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002179 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002181 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2182 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2183 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2184 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2185 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2186 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2187 request.
2188
2189 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2190
2191
2192errorloc303 <code> <url>
2193 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2195 yes | yes | yes | yes
2196 Arguments :
2197 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2198 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2199
2200 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2201 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2202 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2203 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2204 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2205
2206 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2207 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2208 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2209
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002210 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2211
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002212 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2213 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2214 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2215 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002216 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002217
2218 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2219
2220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002221force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2222 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2224 no | yes | yes | yes
2225
2226 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2227 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2228 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2229 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2230 marked down for maintenance operations.
2231
2232 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2233 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2234 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2235 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2236 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2237 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2238 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2239 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2240 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2241
2242 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2243 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2244 is used.
2245
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002246 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002247 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002248
2249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002250fullconn <conns>
2251 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2253 yes | no | yes | yes
2254 Arguments :
2255 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2256 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2257
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002258 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002259 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002260 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002261 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2262 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2263 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2264 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2265 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002266 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002267
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002268 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2269 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2270 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2271
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002272 Example :
2273 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2274 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2275 # connections.
2276 backend dynamic
2277 fullconn 10000
2278 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2279 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2280
2281 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2282
2283
2284grace <time>
2285 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002287 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002288 Arguments :
2289 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2290 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2291 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2292
2293 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2294 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002296 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2297
2298 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2299 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2300 simplify it.
2301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002303hash-type <method>
2304 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2306 yes | no | yes | yes
2307 Arguments :
2308 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2309 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2310 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2311 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2312 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2313 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2314 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2315 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2316 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2317
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002318 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2319 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2320 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2321 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2322 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2323 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2324 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2325 this value.
2326
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002327 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2328 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2329 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2330 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2331 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2332 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2333 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2334 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2335 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2336 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2337 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2338 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2339 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2340
2341 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2342
2343 See also : "balance", "server"
2344
2345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346http-check disable-on-404
2347 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002349 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350 Arguments : none
2351
2352 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2353 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2354 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2355 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2356 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2357 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2358 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2359 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002360 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2361 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2362 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2363
2364 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2365
2366
2367http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2368 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002371 Arguments :
2372 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2373 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2374 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2375 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2376 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2377 details on the supported keywords.
2378
2379 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2380 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2381 with the usual backslash ('\').
2382
2383 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2384 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2385 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2386 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2387 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2388
2389 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2390 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2391 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2392 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2393 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2394
2395 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2396 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2397 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2398 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2399 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2400 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2401
2402 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2403 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2404 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2405 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2406 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2407 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2408 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2409 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2410 trace).
2411
2412 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2413 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2414 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2415 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2416 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2417 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2418 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2419 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2420
2421 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2422 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2423 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2424 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2425 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2426 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2427 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2428 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2429
2430 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2431 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2432
2433 Examples :
2434 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002435 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002436
2437 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002438 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002439
2440 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002441 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002442
2443 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002444 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002446 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002447
2448
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002449http-check send-state
2450 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | no | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2456 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2457 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2458 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2459 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2460
2461 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2462 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2463 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2464 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2465 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2466 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2467 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2468 checked in multiple backends.
2469
2470 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2471 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2472
2473 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2474 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2475 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2476 one fails.
2477
2478 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2479 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2480 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2481
2482 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2483 server's queue.
2484
2485 Example of a header received by the application server :
2486 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2487 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2488
2489 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2490
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002491http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002492 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002493 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2494
2495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 no | yes | yes | yes
2497
2498 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2499 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2500 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002501 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2502 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002503 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2504
2505 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2506 instance.
2507
2508 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002509 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2510 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2511 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002512
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002513 http-request allow if nagios
2514 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2515 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2516 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002517
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002518 Example:
2519 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002520
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002521 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002522
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002523 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2524 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002526id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002527 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2529 no | yes | yes | yes
2530 Arguments : none
2531
2532 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2533 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2534 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002535
2536
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002537ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2538 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 no | yes | yes | yes
2541
2542 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2543 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2544 and running).
2545
2546 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2547 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2548 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2549 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2550 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2551
2552 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2553 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2554
2555 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2556 "unless" condition is met.
2557
2558 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2559
2560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002561log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002562log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002563no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002564 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002567
2568 Prefix :
2569 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2570 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2571 prefix does not allow arguments.
2572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002573 Arguments :
2574 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2575 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2576 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2577 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2578 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2579 parameter.
2580
2581 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2582 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2583
2584 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2585 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2586 standard syslog port).
2587
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002588 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2589 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2590 standard syslog port).
2591
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002592 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2593 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2594 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2595 appropriately writeable).
2596
2597 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2598
2599 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2600 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2601 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2602
2603 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2604 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2605 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002606 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2607 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2608 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2609 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2610 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002611
2612 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2613
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002614 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2615 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2616 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002617
2618 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2619 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2620 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2621 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2622
2623 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2624 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002625
2626 Example :
2627 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002628 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2629 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630
2631
2632maxconn <conns>
2633 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2635 yes | yes | yes | no
2636 Arguments :
2637 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2638 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2639 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2640 closes.
2641
2642 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2643 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2644 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2645 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2646 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2647 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2648 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2649 properly tuned.
2650
2651 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2652 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2653 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2654
2655 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2656
2657
2658mode { tcp|http|health }
2659 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2661 yes | yes | yes | yes
2662 Arguments :
2663 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2664 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2665 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2666 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2667
2668 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2669 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2670 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2671 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2672 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2673
2674 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2675 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2676 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2677 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2678 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2679 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2680
2681 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2682 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2683 will be refused.
2684
2685 Example :
2686 defaults http_instances
2687 mode http
2688
2689 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002692monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696 Arguments :
2697 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2698 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002699 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2701 backend and its backup.
2702
2703 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2704 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2705 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2706 servers in a list of backends.
2707
2708 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2709 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2710 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2711 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2712 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2713 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2714 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002715 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2716 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717
2718 Example:
2719 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2722 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2723 monitor-uri /site_alive
2724 monitor fail if site_dead
2725
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002726 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002727
2728
2729monitor-net <source>
2730 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2732 yes | yes | yes | no
2733 Arguments :
2734 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2735 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2736 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2737 followed by a mask.
2738
2739 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2740 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002741 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002742 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2743
2744 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2745 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2746 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2747 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2748 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2749
2750 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2751 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2752 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2753 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2754 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2755
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002756 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2757 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002759 Example :
2760 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2761 frontend www
2762 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2763
2764 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2765
2766
2767monitor-uri <uri>
2768 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 yes | yes | yes | no
2771 Arguments :
2772 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2773 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2774
2775 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2776 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2777 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2778 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2779 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2780 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2781 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2782 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2783
2784 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2785 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2786 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2787 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2788 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2789 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2790
2791 Example :
2792 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2793 frontend www
2794 mode http
2795 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2796
2797 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2798
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002800option abortonclose
2801no option abortonclose
2802 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 yes | no | yes | yes
2805 Arguments : none
2806
2807 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2808 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2809 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2810 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002811 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002812 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2813 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2814 encountered while delivering the response.
2815
2816 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2817 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2818 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2819 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2820 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2821 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002822 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002823 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002824 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002825 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2826 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2827 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2828
2829 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2830 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2831 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2832 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2833 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2834 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2835 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2836 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002837 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002838
2839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2841
2842 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2843
2844
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002845option accept-invalid-http-request
2846no option accept-invalid-http-request
2847 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 yes | yes | yes | no
2850 Arguments : none
2851
2852 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2853 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2854 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2855 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2856 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2857 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2858 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2859 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2860 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2861
2862 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2863 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2864 been confirmed.
2865
2866 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2867 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2868 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2869 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2870
2871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2873
2874 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2875 stats socket.
2876
2877
2878option accept-invalid-http-response
2879no option accept-invalid-http-response
2880 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | no | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : none
2884
2885 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2886 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2887 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2888 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2889 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2890 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2891 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2892 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2893 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2894
2895 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2896 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2897 been confirmed.
2898
2899 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2900 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2901 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2902 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2903
2904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2906
2907 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2908 stats socket.
2909
2910
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002911option allbackups
2912no option allbackups
2913 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2915 yes | no | yes | yes
2916 Arguments : none
2917
2918 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2919 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2920 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2921 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2922 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2923 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2924 order between the backup servers anymore.
2925
2926 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2927 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2928
2929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2931
2932
2933option checkcache
2934no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002935 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2937 yes | no | yes | yes
2938 Arguments : none
2939
2940 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2941 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002942 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002943 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2944 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002945 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002946
2947 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002948 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002949 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002950 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2951 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002952 to the client are :
2953 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002954 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002955 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002956 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2957 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2958 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2959 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2960 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2961 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2962 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2963 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2964 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2965 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2966 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2967
2968 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002969 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002970 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002971 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2973
2974 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2975 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002976 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002977 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2978
2979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2981
2982
2983option clitcpka
2984no option clitcpka
2985 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2987 yes | yes | yes | no
2988 Arguments : none
2989
2990 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2991 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2992 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2993 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2994
2995 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2996 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2997 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2998 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2999
3000 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3001 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3002 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3003 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3004 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3005
3006 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3007
3008 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3009 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3010 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3011
3012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3014
3015 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3016
3017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018option contstats
3019 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 yes | yes | yes | no
3022 Arguments : none
3023
3024 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3025 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3026 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3027 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3028 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3029 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3030 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3031
3032
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003033option dontlog-normal
3034no option dontlog-normal
3035 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3037 yes | yes | yes | no
3038 Arguments : none
3039
3040 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3041 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3042 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3043 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3044 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3045 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3046 logged.
3047
3048 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3049 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3050 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003052 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003053 logging.
3054
3055
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003056option dontlognull
3057no option dontlognull
3058 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3060 yes | yes | yes | no
3061 Arguments : none
3062
3063 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3064 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3065 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3066 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3067 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3068 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3069 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3070
3071 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3072 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3073 would not be logged.
3074
3075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003078 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003079
3080
3081option forceclose
3082no option forceclose
3083 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003086 Arguments : none
3087
3088 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3089 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3090 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3091 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3092 global session times in the logs.
3093
3094 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003095 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003096 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3097 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3098 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3099 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003100
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003101 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3102 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3103 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3104
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3107
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003108 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003109
3110
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003111option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003112 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3114 yes | yes | yes | yes
3115 Arguments :
3116 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3117 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003118 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003119 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003120
3121 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3122 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3123 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3124 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3125 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3126 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3127 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003128 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3129 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3130 possible that the client has already brought one.
3131
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003132 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003133 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003134 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3135 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003136 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3137 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003138
3139 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3140 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3141 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3142 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3143 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3144 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3145 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3146
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003147 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3148 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3149 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3150 are under the control of the end-user.
3151
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003152 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003153 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3154 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003155 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3156 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3157 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003158
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003159 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3160 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3161 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3162 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3163 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003164
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003165 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003166 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3167 frontend www
3168 mode http
3169 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3170
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003171 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3172 backend www
3173 mode http
3174 option forwardfor header X-Client
3175
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003176 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3177 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003178
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003179
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003180option http-no-delay
3181no option http-no-delay
3182 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 yes | yes | yes | yes
3185 Arguments : none
3186
3187 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3188 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3189 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3190 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3191 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3192 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3193 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3194 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3195 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3196 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3197 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3198 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3199 affected.
3200
3201 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3202 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3203 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3204 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3205 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3206 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3207 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3208 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3209 latency environments.
3210
3211
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003212option http-pretend-keepalive
3213no option http-pretend-keepalive
3214 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 yes | yes | yes | yes
3217 Arguments : none
3218
3219 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3220 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3221 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3222 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3223 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3224 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3225 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3226 consider the response complete.
3227
3228 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3229 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3230 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3231 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3232 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3233 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3234
3235 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3236 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3237 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3238 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3239 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3240 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3241 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3242
3243 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3244 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003245 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3246 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3247 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003248
3249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3251
3252 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3253
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003254
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003255option http-server-close
3256no option http-server-close
3257 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | yes
3260 Arguments : none
3261
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003262 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3263 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3264 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3265 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3266 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3267 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3268 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3269 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3270 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3271 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3272 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3273 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003274
3275 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3276 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3277 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3278 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003279 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3280 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003281
3282 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3283 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003284 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3285 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3286 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003287
3288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3290
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003291 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3292 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003293
3294
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003295option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003296no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003297 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3299 yes | yes | yes | no
3300 Arguments : none
3301
3302 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3303 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3304 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3305 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3306 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3307 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3308 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3309
3310 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3311 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3312 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3313 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3314 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3315 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3316 request along its whole life.
3317
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003318 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3319 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3320 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3321 front of an existing proxy.
3322
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003323 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3324
3325 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3326 http-server-close".
3327
3328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003329option httpchk
3330option httpchk <uri>
3331option httpchk <method> <uri>
3332option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3333 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | no | yes | yes
3336 Arguments :
3337 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3338 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3339 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3340 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3341 ones.
3342
3343 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3344 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3345 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3346
3347 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3348 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3349 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3350 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3351 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3352
3353 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3354 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3355 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3356 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3357 the lack of any response.
3358
3359 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3360
3361 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3362 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3363 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3364
3365 Examples :
3366 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3367 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3368 backend https_relay
3369 mode tcp
3370 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3371 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3372
3373 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003374 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3375 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003376
3377
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003378option httpclose
3379no option httpclose
3380 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3382 yes | yes | yes | yes
3383 Arguments : none
3384
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003385 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3386 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3387 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3388 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3389 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3390 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3391 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003392
3393 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003394 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3395 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3396 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3397 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3398 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3399 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003400
3401 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3402 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3403 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003404 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3405 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003406
3407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3409
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003410 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3411 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003412
3413
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003414option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003415 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003418 Arguments :
3419 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3420 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3421 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3422 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3423 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003424
3425 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3426 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3427 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3428 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3429 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3430 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3431 ports.
3432
3433 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3434
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3437 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3438 by default.
3439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003440 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003441
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003442
3443option http_proxy
3444no option http_proxy
3445 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | yes | yes | yes
3448 Arguments : none
3449
3450 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3451 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3452 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3453 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3454 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3455
3456 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3457 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3458 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3459 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003460 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003461 be analyzed.
3462
3463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3465
3466 Example :
3467 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3468 backend direct_forward
3469 option httpclose
3470 option http_proxy
3471
3472 See also : "option httpclose"
3473
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003474
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003475option independant-streams
3476no option independant-streams
3477 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | yes | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3483 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3484 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3485 receive data or not.
3486
3487 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3488 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3489 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3490 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3491 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3492 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3493 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3494 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3495 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3496 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3497 socket buffers.
3498
3499 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3500 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3501 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3502 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3503 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3504
3505 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3506
3507
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003508option ldap-check
3509 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3511 yes | no | yes | yes
3512 Arguments : none
3513
3514 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3515 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3516 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3517 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3518
3519 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3520 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3521
3522 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3523 configure it.
3524
3525 Example :
3526 option ldap-check
3527
3528 See also : "option httpchk"
3529
3530
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003531option log-health-checks
3532no option log-health-checks
3533 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | no | yes | yes
3536 Arguments : none
3537
3538 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3539 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3540 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3541 of additional information is limited.
3542
3543 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3544 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3545
3546 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3547
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003548
3549option log-separate-errors
3550no option log-separate-errors
3551 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 yes | yes | yes | no
3554 Arguments : none
3555
3556 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3557 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3558 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3559 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3560 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3561 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3562 provides very important information.
3563
3564 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3565 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3566 error logs.
3567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003568 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003569 logging.
3570
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003571
3572option logasap
3573no option logasap
3574 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | yes | yes | no
3577 Arguments : none
3578
3579 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3580 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3581 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3582 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3583 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3584 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3585 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003586 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003587 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3588 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003590 Examples :
3591 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3592 mode http
3593 option httplog
3594 option logasap
3595 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3596
3597 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3598 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3599 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3600 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003602 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003603 logging.
3604
3605
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003606option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3607 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003610 Arguments :
3611 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3612 to MySQL server.
3613
3614 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3615 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3616 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3617 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3618 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3619 in the MySQL table, like this :
3620
3621 USE mysql;
3622 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3623 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3624
3625 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3626 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3627 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3628 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3629 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3630 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3631 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3632 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3633 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3634
3635 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3636 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003637
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003638 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003639
3640 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3641 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3642 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3643 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3644 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3645 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3646
3647 See also: "option httpchk"
3648
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003649option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3650 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 yes | no | yes | yes
3653 Arguments :
3654 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3655 to PostgreSQL server.
3656
3657 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3658 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3659 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3660 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3661
3662 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003663
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003664option nolinger
3665no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003666 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003669 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003670
3671 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3672 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3673 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3674 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3675 connections.
3676
3677 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3678 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3679 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3680 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3681 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3682 this too.
3683
3684 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3685 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3686 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3687
3688 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3689 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3690 for servers.
3691
3692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3694
3695
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003696option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3697 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments :
3701 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3702 matching <network>
3703 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3704 header name.
3705
3706 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3707 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3708 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3709 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3710 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3711 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3712 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3713 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3714 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3715 possible that the client has already brought one.
3716
3717 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3718 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3719 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3720 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3721 header and requires different one.
3722
3723 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3724 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3725 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3726 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3727 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3728 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3729 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3730
3731 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3732 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3733 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3734 both are defined.
3735
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003736 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3737 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3738 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3739 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3740 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003741
3742 Examples :
3743 # Original Destination address
3744 frontend www
3745 mode http
3746 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3747
3748 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3749 backend www
3750 mode http
3751 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3752
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003753 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3754 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003755
3756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003757option persist
3758no option persist
3759 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003762 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003763
3764 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3765 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3766 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3767 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3768 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3769 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3770 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3771 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3772 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3773 redirected to another valid server.
3774
3775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3777
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003778 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003779
3780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003781option redispatch
3782no option redispatch
3783 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003786 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003787
3788 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3789 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3790 be able to access the service anymore.
3791
3792 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3793 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3794
3795 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3796 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3797 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003799 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3800 "redisp" keywords.
3801
3802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3804
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003805 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003806
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003807
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003808option redis-check
3809 Use redis health checks for server testing
3810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | no | yes | yes
3812 Arguments : none
3813
3814 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3815 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3816 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3817 find the "+PONG" response message.
3818
3819 Example :
3820 option redis-check
3821
3822 See also : "option httpchk"
3823
3824
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003825option smtpchk
3826option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3827 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003831 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3832 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3833 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3834
3835 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3836 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3837 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3838
3839 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3840 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3841 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3842 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3843 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3844 dead server.
3845
3846 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3847 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3848 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3849 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3850
3851 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3852 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3853 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3854 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3855 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3856
3857 Example :
3858 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3859
3860 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003863option socket-stats
3864no option socket-stats
3865
3866 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | yes | yes | no
3869
3870 Arguments : none
3871
3872
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003873option splice-auto
3874no option splice-auto
3875 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | yes | yes | yes
3878 Arguments : none
3879
3880 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3881 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3882 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3883 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003884 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003885 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3886 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3887 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3888 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3889
3890 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3891 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3892 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3893 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3894 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3895 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3896 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3897 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3898 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3899 keyword.
3900
3901 Example :
3902 option splice-auto
3903
3904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3906
3907 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3908 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3909
3910
3911option splice-request
3912no option splice-request
3913 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | yes | yes | yes
3916 Arguments : none
3917
3918 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3919 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3920 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3921 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3922 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3923 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3924
3925 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3926
3927 Example :
3928 option splice-request
3929
3930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3932
3933 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3934 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3935
3936
3937option splice-response
3938no option splice-response
3939 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | yes | yes | yes
3942 Arguments : none
3943
3944 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3945 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3946 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3947 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3948 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3949 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3950
3951 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3952
3953 Example :
3954 option splice-response
3955
3956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3958
3959 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3960 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3961
3962
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003963option srvtcpka
3964no option srvtcpka
3965 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3967 yes | no | yes | yes
3968 Arguments : none
3969
3970 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3971 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3972 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3973 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3974
3975 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3976 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3977 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3978 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3979
3980 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3981 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3982 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3983 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3984 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3985
3986 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3987
3988 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3989 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3990 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3991
3992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3994
3995 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3996
3997
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003998option ssl-hello-chk
3999 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | no | yes | yes
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4005 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4006 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4007 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4008 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4009 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4010 hello message.
4011
4012 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4013 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4014 messages, which is appreciable.
4015
4016 See also: "option httpchk"
4017
4018
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004019option tcp-smart-accept
4020no option tcp-smart-accept
4021 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4023 yes | yes | yes | no
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4027 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4028 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4029 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4030 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4031 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4032
4033 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4034 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4035 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4036 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4037
4038 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4039 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4040 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4041 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4042
4043 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4044 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4045 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4046
4047 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4048 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4049 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4050
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004051 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4052
4053
4054option tcp-smart-connect
4055no option tcp-smart-connect
4056 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4058 yes | no | yes | yes
4059 Arguments : none
4060
4061 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4062 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4063 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4064 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4065 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4066
4067 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4068 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4069 complex.
4070
4071 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4072 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4073 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4074
4075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4077
4078 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4079
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004080
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004081option tcpka
4082 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 yes | yes | yes | yes
4085 Arguments : none
4086
4087 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4088 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4089 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4090 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4091
4092 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4093 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4094 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4095 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4096
4097 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4098 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4099 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4100 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4101 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4102
4103 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4104
4105 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4106 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4107 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4108 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4109 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4110 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4111 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4112 backends.
4113
4114 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4115
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004116
4117option tcplog
4118 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4120 yes | yes | yes | yes
4121 Arguments : none
4122
4123 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4124 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4125 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4126 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4127 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4128 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4129 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4130 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4131
4132 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004134 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004135
4136
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004137option transparent
4138no option transparent
4139 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004141 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004142 Arguments : none
4143
4144 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4145 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4146 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4147 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4148 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4149 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4150 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4151 appropriate server.
4152
4153 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4154 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4155
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004156 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004157 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004158
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004159
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004160persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004161persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004162 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | no | yes | yes
4165 Arguments :
4166 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004167 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4168 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004169
4170 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4171 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4172 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4173 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4174 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4175 forwarded to this server.
4176
4177 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4178 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4179 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004180 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004181 a single "listen" section.
4182
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004183 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4184 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4185 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4186
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004187 Example :
4188 listen tse-farm
4189 bind :3389
4190 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4191 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4192 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4193 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4194 persist rdp-cookie
4195 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4196 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4197 balance rdp-cookie
4198 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4199 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4200
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004201 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4202 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004203
4204
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004205rate-limit sessions <rate>
4206 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 yes | yes | yes | no
4209 Arguments :
4210 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4211 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4212
4213 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4214 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4215 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4216 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4217 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4218 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4219
4220 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4221 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4222 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4223 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4224
4225 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4226 listen smtp
4227 mode tcp
4228 bind :25
4229 rate-limit sessions 10
4230 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4231
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004232 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4233 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4234 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004235
4236 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4237
4238
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004239redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4240redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004241 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4243 no | yes | yes | yes
4244
4245 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004246 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004247
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004248 Arguments :
4249 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4250 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4251 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4252 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004253 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4254 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4255 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4256 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004257
4258 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4259 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4260 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4261 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4262 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4263 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4264 location with a GET method.
4265
4266 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4267 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4268
4269 - "drop-query"
4270 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4271 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4272 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4273 with a location-type redirect.
4274
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004275 - "append-slash"
4276 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4277 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4278 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4279 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4280
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004281 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4282 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4283 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4284 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4285 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4286 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4287 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4288
4289 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4290 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4291 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4292 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4293 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4294 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4295 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004296
4297 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4298 acl clear dst_port 80
4299 acl secure dst_port 8080
4300 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004301 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004302 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004303 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4304
4305 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004306 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4307 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4308 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004309 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004310
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004311 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4312 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4313 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004315 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004316
4317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004318redisp (deprecated)
4319redispatch (deprecated)
4320 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004323 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004324
4325 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4326 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4327 be able to access the service anymore.
4328
4329 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4330 redistribute them to a working server.
4331
4332 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4333 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4334 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004336 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4337 "option redispatch" instead.
4338
4339 See also : "option redispatch"
4340
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004341
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004342reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004343 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 no | yes | yes | yes
4346 Arguments :
4347 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4348 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004349 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004350
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004351 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4352 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4353
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004354 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4355 the last header of an HTTP request.
4356
4357 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4358 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4359 responses.
4360
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004361 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4362 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4363 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4364
4365 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4366 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004367
4368
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004369reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4370reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004371 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 no | yes | yes | yes
4374 Arguments :
4375 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4376 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4377 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4378 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4379 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4380 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4381 ignores case.
4382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004383 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4384 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004386 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4387 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4388 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4389 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004390 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004391
4392 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4393 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4394
4395 Example :
4396 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4397 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4398 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004400 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4401 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402
4403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004404reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4405reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004406 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 no | yes | yes | yes
4409 Arguments :
4410 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4411 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4412 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4413 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4414 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4415 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004417 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4418 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4419
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004420 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4421 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4422 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4423 next servers.
4424
4425 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4426 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4427 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4428
4429 Example :
4430 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4431 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4432 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4433
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004434 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4435 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004436
4437
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004438reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4439reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004440 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 no | yes | yes | yes
4443 Arguments :
4444 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4445 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4446 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4447 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4448 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4449 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4450 case.
4451
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004452 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4453 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4454
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004455 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4456 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4457 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4458 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004459 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004461 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004462 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004463 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004464
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004465 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4466 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4467
4468 Example :
4469 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4470 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4471 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004473 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4474 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004475
4476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004477reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4478reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004479 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 no | yes | yes | yes
4482 Arguments :
4483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4484 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4485 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4486 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4487 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4488 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4489 case.
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004494 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4495 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4496 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4497 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4498
4499 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4500 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4501
4502 Example :
4503 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4504 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4505 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4506 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004508 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4509 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004510
4511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004512reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4513reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004514 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 no | yes | yes | yes
4517 Arguments :
4518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4519 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4520 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4521 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4522 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4523 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4524
4525 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4526 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4527 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4528 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004529 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004530
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004531 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4532 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4533
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004534 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4535 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4536 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4537
4538 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4539 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4540 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4541 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4542 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4543
4544 Example :
4545 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4546 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4547 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4548 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4549
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004550 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4551 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
4553
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004554reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4555reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004556 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 no | yes | yes | yes
4559 Arguments :
4560 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4561 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4562 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4563 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4564 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4565 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4566 ignores case.
4567
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004568 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4569 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4570
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004571 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4572 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004573 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4574 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4575 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4577 not set.
4578
4579 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4580 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4581 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4582 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4583 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4584
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004585 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4587 # block all others.
4588 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4589 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4590
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004591 # block bad guys
4592 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4593 reqitarpit . if badguys
4594
4595 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4596 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004597
4598
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004599retries <value>
4600 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4602 yes | no | yes | yes
4603 Arguments :
4604 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4605 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4606 default value is 3.
4607
4608 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4609 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4610 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4611
4612 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4613 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4614
4615 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4616 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4617
4618 See also : "option redispatch"
4619
4620
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004621rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 no | yes | yes | yes
4625 Arguments :
4626 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4627 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004628 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004629
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004630 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4631 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4632
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004633 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4634 the last header of an HTTP response.
4635
4636 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4637 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4638 responses.
4639
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004640 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4641 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004642
4643
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004644rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4645rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004646 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 no | yes | yes | yes
4649 Arguments :
4650 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4651 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4652 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4653 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4654 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4655 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4656 ignores case.
4657
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004658 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4659 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4660
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004661 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4662 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004663 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004664 client.
4665
4666 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4667 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4668 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4669
4670 Example :
4671 # remove the Server header from responses
4672 reqidel ^Server:.*
4673
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004674 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4675 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004676
4677
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004678rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4679rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004680 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 no | yes | yes | yes
4683 Arguments :
4684 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4685 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4686 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4687 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4688 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4689 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4690 ignores case.
4691
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004692 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4693 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4694
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004695 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4696 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4697 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4698 case-sensitive.
4699
4700 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004701 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4702 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4703 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704
4705 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4706 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4707
4708 Example :
4709 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4710 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4711
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004712 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4713 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714
4715
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004716rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4717rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004718 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 no | yes | yes | yes
4721 Arguments :
4722 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4723 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4724 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4725 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4726 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4727 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4728 ignores case.
4729
4730 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4731 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4732 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4733 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004734 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004735
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004736 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4737 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4738
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004739 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4740 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4741 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4742
4743 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4744 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4745 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4746 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4747 are not case-sensitive.
4748
4749 Example :
4750 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4751 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4752
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004753 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4754 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004755
4756
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004757server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004758 Declare a server in a backend
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 no | no | yes | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4763 appear in logs and alerts.
4764
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004765 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4766 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4767 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4768 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004769 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4770 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4771 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4772 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4773 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4774 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004775
4776 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4777 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4778 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4779 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4780 adding this value to the client's port.
4781
4782 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4783 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004784 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004785
4786 Examples :
4787 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4788 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004790 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004791
4792
4793source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004794source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004795source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004796 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | no | yes | yes
4799 Arguments :
4800 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4801 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4802 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4803 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4804
4805 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4806 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004807 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4808 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4809 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004810
4811 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4812 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4813 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4814 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4815 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4816 <addr>.
4817
4818 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4819 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4820 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4821 port.
4822
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004823 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4824 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4825 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4826 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4827 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4828 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4829 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4830 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4831 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4832 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4833 HTTP header.
4834
4835 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4836 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4837 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4838 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4839 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4840 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4841 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4842 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4843 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4844 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4845
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004846 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4847 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4848 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4849 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4850 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4851 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4852
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004853 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4854 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4855 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4856 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4857
4858 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4859 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4860 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4861 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4862 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4863 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4864
4865 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4866 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4867 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4868 there are two methods :
4869
4870 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4871 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4872 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4873 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4874 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4875 of the client ranges may be used.
4876
4877 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4878 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4879 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4880 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4881 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4882 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4883 same session.
4884
4885 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4886 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4887 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4888 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4889 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4890 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4891
4892 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4893 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4894 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004895 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004896
4897 Examples :
4898 backend private
4899 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4900 source 192.168.1.200
4901
4902 backend transparent_ssl1
4903 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4904 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4905
4906 backend transparent_ssl2
4907 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4908 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4909 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4910
4911 backend transparent_ssl3
4912 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4913 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4914 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4915
4916 backend transparent_smtp
4917 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4918 # with Tproxy version 4.
4919 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4920
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004921 backend transparent_http
4922 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4923 # proxy.
4924 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004926 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004927 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004929
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004930srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4931 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | no | yes | yes
4934 Arguments :
4935 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4937 as explained at the top of this document.
4938
4939 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4940 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4941 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4942 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4943 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4944 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4945 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4946
4947 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4948 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4949 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4950 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4951 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004952 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004953 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004954 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004955
4956 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4957 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4958 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4959 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4960 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4961 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4962
4963 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4964 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4965
4966 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4967
4968
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004969stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4970 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 no | no | yes | yes
4973
4974 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4975 matched.
4976
4977 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4978 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004980 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4981 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4982 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4983
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004984 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4985 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4986 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4987 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004988
4989 Example :
4990 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4991 backend stats_localhost
4992 stats enable
4993 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4994
4995 Example :
4996 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4997 backend stats_auth
4998 stats enable
4999 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5000 stats admin if TRUE
5001
5002 Example :
5003 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5004 userlist stats-auth
5005 group admin users admin
5006 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5007 group readonly users haproxy
5008 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5009
5010 backend stats_auth
5011 stats enable
5012 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5013 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5014 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5015 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5016
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005017 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5018 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5019 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005020
5021
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005022stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5023 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 yes | no | yes | yes
5026 Arguments :
5027 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5028
5029 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5030
5031 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5032 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5033 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5034 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5035 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5036 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5037
5038 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5039 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5040 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005041 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005042
5043 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5044 report using "stats scope".
5045
5046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5048 unobvious parameters.
5049
5050 Example :
5051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5052 backend public_www
5053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5054 stats enable
5055 stats hide-version
5056 stats scope .
5057 stats uri /admin?stats
5058 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5061
5062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5063 backend private_monitoring
5064 stats enable
5065 stats uri /admin?stats
5066 stats refresh 5s
5067
5068 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5069
5070
5071stats enable
5072 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | no | yes | yes
5075 Arguments : none
5076
5077 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5078 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5079 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5080 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5081 - stats auth : no authentication
5082 - stats scope : no restriction
5083
5084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5086 unobvious parameters.
5087
5088 Example :
5089 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5090 backend public_www
5091 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5092 stats enable
5093 stats hide-version
5094 stats scope .
5095 stats uri /admin?stats
5096 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5097 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5098 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5099
5100 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5101 backend private_monitoring
5102 stats enable
5103 stats uri /admin?stats
5104 stats refresh 5s
5105
5106 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5107
5108
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005109stats hide-version
5110 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005113 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005114
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005115 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5116 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5117 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5118 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5119 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5120 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5124 unobvious parameters.
5125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005126 Example :
5127 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5128 backend public_www
5129 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005130 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005131 stats hide-version
5132 stats scope .
5133 stats uri /admin?stats
5134 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5135 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5136 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005137
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005138 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5139 backend private_monitoring
5140 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005141 stats uri /admin?stats
5142 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005143
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005144 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005145
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005146
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005147stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5149 Access control for statistics
5150
5151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 no | no | yes | yes
5153
5154 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5155 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5156 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5157 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5158 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5159 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5160
5161 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5162 instance.
5163
5164 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5165 about ACL usage.
5166
5167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005168stats realm <realm>
5169 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5171 yes | no | yes | yes
5172 Arguments :
5173 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5174 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5175 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5176
5177 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5178 using a backslash ('\').
5179
5180 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5181 only related to authentication.
5182
5183 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5184 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5185 unobvious parameters.
5186
5187 Example :
5188 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5189 backend public_www
5190 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5191 stats enable
5192 stats hide-version
5193 stats scope .
5194 stats uri /admin?stats
5195 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5196 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5197 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5198
5199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5200 backend private_monitoring
5201 stats enable
5202 stats uri /admin?stats
5203 stats refresh 5s
5204
5205 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5206
5207
5208stats refresh <delay>
5209 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5211 yes | no | yes | yes
5212 Arguments :
5213 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5214 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5215 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5216 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5217 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5218 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5219
5220 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5221 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5222 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5223 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5224
5225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5227 unobvious parameters.
5228
5229 Example :
5230 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5231 backend public_www
5232 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5233 stats enable
5234 stats hide-version
5235 stats scope .
5236 stats uri /admin?stats
5237 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5238 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5239 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5240
5241 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5242 backend private_monitoring
5243 stats enable
5244 stats uri /admin?stats
5245 stats refresh 5s
5246
5247 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5248
5249
5250stats scope { <name> | "." }
5251 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | no | yes | yes
5254 Arguments :
5255 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5256 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5257 section in which the statement appears.
5258
5259 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5260 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5261 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5262 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5263 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5264 exists.
5265
5266 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5267 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5268 unobvious parameters.
5269
5270 Example :
5271 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5272 backend public_www
5273 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5274 stats enable
5275 stats hide-version
5276 stats scope .
5277 stats uri /admin?stats
5278 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5279 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5280 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5281
5282 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5283 backend private_monitoring
5284 stats enable
5285 stats uri /admin?stats
5286 stats refresh 5s
5287
5288 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005290
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005291stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005292 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 yes | no | yes | yes
5295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005296 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005297 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5298
5299 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5300 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5301
5302 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5303 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5304 unobvious parameters.
5305
5306 Example :
5307 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5308 backend private_monitoring
5309 stats enable
5310 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5311 stats uri /admin?stats
5312 stats refresh 5s
5313
5314 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5315 global section.
5316
5317
5318stats show-legends
5319 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5320 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5321 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5322 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5323 - IP (socket, server)
5324 - cookie (backend, server)
5325
5326 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5327 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5328 unobvious parameters.
5329
5330 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5331
5332
5333stats show-node [ <name> ]
5334 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | yes | yes
5337 Arguments:
5338 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5339 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5340
5341 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5342 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5343 provided for each customer.
5344
5345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5347 unobvious parameters.
5348
5349 Example:
5350 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5351 backend private_monitoring
5352 stats enable
5353 stats show-node Europe-1
5354 stats uri /admin?stats
5355 stats refresh 5s
5356
5357 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5358 section.
5359
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005360
5361stats uri <prefix>
5362 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | no | yes | yes
5365 Arguments :
5366 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5367 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5368 query string.
5369
5370 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5371 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5372 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5373 possible to reach it in the application.
5374
5375 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005376 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005377 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5378 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5379 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5380 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5381
5382 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5383 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5384 an address or a port to statistics only.
5385
5386 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5387 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5388 unobvious parameters.
5389
5390 Example :
5391 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5392 backend public_www
5393 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5394 stats enable
5395 stats hide-version
5396 stats scope .
5397 stats uri /admin?stats
5398 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5399 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5400 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5401
5402 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5403 backend private_monitoring
5404 stats enable
5405 stats uri /admin?stats
5406 stats refresh 5s
5407
5408 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5409
5410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005411stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5412 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005414 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005415
5416 Arguments :
5417 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5418 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5419 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5420 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5421
5422 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5423 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5424 the "stick-table" statement.
5425
5426 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5427 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5428 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5429 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5430 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5431
5432 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5433 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5434 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5435 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5436 transformation rules.
5437
5438 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5439 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5440 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5441 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5442 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5443 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5444 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5445
5446 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5447 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5448 ACL based conditions.
5449
5450 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5451 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5452 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5453 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5454
5455 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5456 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5457 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5458 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5459
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005460 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5461 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5462 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5463
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005464 Example :
5465 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5466 # last 30 minutes
5467 backend pop
5468 mode tcp
5469 balance roundrobin
5470 stick store-request src
5471 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5472 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5473 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5474
5475 backend smtp
5476 mode tcp
5477 balance roundrobin
5478 stick match src table pop
5479 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5480 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5481
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005482 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5483 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005484
5485
5486stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5487 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 no | no | yes | yes
5490
5491 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5492 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5493 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5494 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5498 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5499
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005500 Examples :
5501 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005502 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005503
5504 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5505 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5506 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5507
5508
5509 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5510 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5511 backend http
5512 mode http
5513 balance roundrobin
5514 stick on src table https
5515 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5516 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5517 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5518
5519 backend https
5520 mode tcp
5521 balance roundrobin
5522 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5523 stick on src
5524 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5525 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5526
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005527 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005528
5529
5530stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5531 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5533 no | no | yes | yes
5534
5535 Arguments :
5536 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5537 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5538 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5539 server is selected.
5540
5541 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5542 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5543 the "stick-table" statement.
5544
5545 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5546 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5547 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5548 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5549 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5550 address.
5551
5552 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5553 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5554 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5555 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5556 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5557 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5558 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5559 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5560 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5561 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5562
5563 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5564 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5565 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5566 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5567 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5568 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5569 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5570
5571 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5572 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5573 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5574 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5575
5576 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5577 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5578 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5579 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5580 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5581 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5582 another protocol or access method.
5583
5584 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5585 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5586 the request.
5587
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005588 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5589 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5590 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5591
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005592 Example :
5593 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5594 # last 30 minutes
5595 backend pop
5596 mode tcp
5597 balance roundrobin
5598 stick store-request src
5599 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5600 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5601 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5602
5603 backend smtp
5604 mode tcp
5605 balance roundrobin
5606 stick match src table pop
5607 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5608 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5609
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005610 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5611 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005612
5613
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005614stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005615 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5616 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005617 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005619 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005620
5621 Arguments :
5622 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5623 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5624 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5625 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5626
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005627 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5628 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5629 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5630 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5631
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005632 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5633 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5634 instance.
5635
5636 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5637 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5638 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5639 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5640 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5641 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005642 to 32 characters.
5643
5644 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5645 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5646 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5647 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5648 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5649 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005650
5651 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005652 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5653 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005654 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5655 increase.
5656
5657 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005658 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5659 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5660 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005661
5662 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5663 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5664 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5665 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5666 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5667 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5668 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5669 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5670 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5671 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5672 parameter (see below).
5673
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005674 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5675 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5676 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5677 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5678 soft restart.
5679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005680 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5681
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005682 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5683 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5684 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5685 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5686 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5687 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5688 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5689 if not expiration delay is specified.
5690
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005691 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5692 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5693 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5694 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005695 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5696 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5697 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5698 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5699 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5700 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5701 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5702 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5703 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5704 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5705 types and their arguments.
5706
5707 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5708 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5709 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5710 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5711
5712 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5713 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5714 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5715 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5716
5717 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5718 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5719 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5720 they were received.
5721
5722 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5723 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5724 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5725 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5726 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5727
5728 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5729 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5730 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5731 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5732 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5733
5734 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5735 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5736 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5737
5738 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5739 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5740 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5741 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5742 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5743
5744 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5745 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5746 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5747 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5748 the client side.
5749
5750 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5751 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5752 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5753 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5754 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5755 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5756 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5757
5758 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5759 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5760 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5761 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5762 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5763 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5764 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5765
5766 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5769 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5770 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5771 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5772
5773 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5774 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5775 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5776 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5777
5778 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5779 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5780 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5781 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5782 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5783 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5784 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5785 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5786 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5787 recommended for better fairness.
5788
5789 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5790 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5791 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5792 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5793
5794 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5795 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5796 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5797 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5798 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5799 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5800 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5801 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5802 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5803 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005804
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005805 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5806 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005807 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5808 reference it.
5809
5810 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5811 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5812 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5813 as an exclusive stickiness.
5814
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005815 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5816 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5817 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5818 something that can be ignored.
5819
5820 Example:
5821 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5822 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5823 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5824 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5825
5826 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005827 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005828
5829
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005830stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5831 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 no | no | yes | yes
5834
5835 Arguments :
5836 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5837 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5838 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5839 server is selected.
5840
5841 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5842 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5843 the "stick-table" statement.
5844
5845 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5846 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5847 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5848 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5849
5850 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5851 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5852 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5853 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5854 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5855 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5856 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5857 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5858 rules.
5859
5860 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5861 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5862 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5863 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5864 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5865 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5866 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5867
5868 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5869 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5870 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5871 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5872
5873 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5874 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5875 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5876 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5877 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5878 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5879 another protocol or access method.
5880
5881 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5882
5883 Example :
5884 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5885 backend https
5886 mode tcp
5887 balance roundrobin
5888 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5889 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5890
5891 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5892 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5893
5894 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5895 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5896 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5897
5898 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5899 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5900
5901 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5902 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5903 # at offset 44.
5904
5905 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5906 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5907
5908 # Learn on response if server hello.
5909 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5910
5911 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5912 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5913
5914 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5915 extraction.
5916
5917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005918tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5919 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5921 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005922 Arguments :
5923 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5924 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5925 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005928
5929 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5930 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005931 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5932 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5933 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5934 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5935 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5936 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005938 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5939 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5940 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5941 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005943 Three types of actions are supported :
5944 - accept :
5945 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5946 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5947 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005948
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005949 - reject :
5950 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5951 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5952 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5953 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5954 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5955 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5956 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5957 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5958 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5959 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5960 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5961 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005963 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5964 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5965 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5966 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5967 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5968 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5969 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5970 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5971 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 These actions take one or two arguments :
5974 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5975 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5976 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5979 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5980 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5981 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005983 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5984 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5985 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5986 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5987 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5988 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5989 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5990 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5991 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5992 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005994 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5995 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5996 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005998 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5999 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6000 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006002 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006003 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006004 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006006 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6007 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6008 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006010 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6011 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6012 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006013
6014 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006016 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006017
6018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006019tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6020 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006022 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006023 Arguments :
6024 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6025 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6026 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006030 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6031 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6032 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6033 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6034 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6037 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6038 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6039 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6040 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6041 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6042 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6043 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6044 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6047 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6048 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6049 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006051 Three types of actions are supported :
6052 - accept :
6053 - reject :
6054 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6057 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006059 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6060 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6061 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6062 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6063 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6064 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006066 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6068 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006070 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6071 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6072 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6073 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6074 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075
6076 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006077 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6078 # and reject everything else.
6079 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6080 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6081 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6082 tcp-request content reject
6083
6084 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006085 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6086 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6087 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006088 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006089
6090 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6091 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6092 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006093 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006094 tcp-request content reject
6095
6096 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6097 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6098
6099 frontend http
6100 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6101 # protecting all our sites
6102 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6103 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6104 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6105 ...
6106 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6107
6108 backend http_dynamic
6109 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6110 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6111 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6112 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6113 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6114 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6115 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006117 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006119 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006120
6121
6122tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6123 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006125 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006126 Arguments :
6127 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6128 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6129 as explained at the top of this document.
6130
6131 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6132 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6133 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6134 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6135 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6136
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006137 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6138 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6139 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6140 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6141
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006142 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6143 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006144 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006146 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6147 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6148 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6149 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150
6151 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6152 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6153 it pass through unaffected.
6154
6155 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6156 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6157 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006158 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006159 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6160 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006161 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6162 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6163 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006164
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006165 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006166 "timeout client".
6167
6168
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006169tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6170 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 no | no | yes | yes
6173 Arguments :
6174 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6175 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6176 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6177
6178 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6179
6180 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6181 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6182 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6183 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6184 set and expires with no matching rule.
6185
6186 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6187
6188 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6189 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6190 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6191 inserted.
6192
6193 Two types of actions are supported :
6194 - accept :
6195 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6196 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6197 the rules evaluation.
6198
6199 - reject :
6200 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6201 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6202 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6203
6204 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6205 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6206 for changing the default action to a reject.
6207
6208 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6209 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6210 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6211 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6212 period.
6213
6214 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6215
6216 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6217
6218
6219tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6220 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 no | no | yes | yes
6223 Arguments :
6224 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6225 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6226 as explained at the top of this document.
6227
6228 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6229
6230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006231timeout check <timeout>
6232 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6233 established.
6234
6235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6236 yes | no | yes | yes
6237 Arguments:
6238 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6239 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6240 as explained at the top of this document.
6241
6242 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6243 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6244 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6245 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006246 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6247 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6248 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006249
6250 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6251 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6252
6253 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6254 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006255 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006256
6257 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6258 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6259 forget about it.
6260
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006261 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6262 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006263
6264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006265timeout client <timeout>
6266timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6267 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | yes | yes | no
6270 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6273 as explained at the top of this document.
6274
6275 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6276 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6277 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6278 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6279 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6280 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6281 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6282 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006283 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006284 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6285 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6286
6287 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6288 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6289 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6290 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6291 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6292 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6293
6294 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6295 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6296 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6297
6298 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6299
6300
6301timeout connect <timeout>
6302timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6303 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6305 yes | no | yes | yes
6306 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6309 as explained at the top of this document.
6310
6311 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006312 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006313 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006314 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006315 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6316 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006317
6318 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6319 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6320 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6321 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6322 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6323 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6324
6325 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6326 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6327 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6328
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006329 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6330 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006331
6332
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006333timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6334 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | yes | yes | yes
6337 Arguments :
6338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6340 as explained at the top of this document.
6341
6342 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6343 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6344 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6345 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6346 once the request has started to present itself.
6347
6348 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6349 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6350 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6351 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6352 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6353
6354 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6355 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6356 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6357 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6358
6359 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6360 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6361 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6362 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6363 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006364 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006365
6366 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6367 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6368 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6369 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6370
6371 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6372
6373
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006374timeout http-request <timeout>
6375 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006377 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006378 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6381 as explained at the top of this document.
6382
6383 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6384 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6385 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6386 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6387 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6388 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6389 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6390 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6391
6392 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6393 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006394 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6395 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006396
6397 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6398 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6399 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6400 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6401 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6402
6403 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006404 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6405 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6406 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006407
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006408 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006409
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006410
6411timeout queue <timeout>
6412 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | no | yes | yes
6415 Arguments :
6416 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6417 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6418 as explained at the top of this document.
6419
6420 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6421 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6422 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6423 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6424 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6425
6426 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6427 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6428 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6429 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6430
6431 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6432
6433
6434timeout server <timeout>
6435timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6436 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | no | yes | yes
6439 Arguments :
6440 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6441 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6442 as explained at the top of this document.
6443
6444 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6445 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6446 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6447 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6448 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6449 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6450 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6451
6452 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6453 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6454 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6455 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6456 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006457 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006458 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006459 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006460
6461 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6462 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6463 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6464 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6465 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6466 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6467
6468 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6469 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6470 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6471
6472 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6473
6474
6475timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006476 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6478 yes | yes | yes | yes
6479 Arguments :
6480 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6481 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6482 as explained at the top of this document.
6483
6484 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6485 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6486 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6487
6488 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6489 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6490 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6491 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006492 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006493
6494 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6495
6496
6497transparent (deprecated)
6498 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006500 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006501 Arguments : none
6502
6503 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6504 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6505 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6506 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6507 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6508 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6509 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6510 appropriate server.
6511
6512 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6513
6514 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6515 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006517 See also: "option transparent"
6518
6519
6520use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6521use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006522 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6524 no | yes | yes | no
6525 Arguments :
6526 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006528 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006529
6530 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6531 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6532 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006533 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6534 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6535 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6536 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006537
6538 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6539 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6540 assign the backend.
6541
6542 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6543 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6544 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6545 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6546 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6547 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6548
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006549 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006550 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006551 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6552 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6553 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6554
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006555 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006556
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010065585. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006559------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006561The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6562which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6563arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6564settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6565after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6566Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6567address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006569 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006570 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006572The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006574addr <ipv4>
6575 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6576 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6577 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6578 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6579 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006581 Supported in default-server: No
6582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006583backup
6584 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6585 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6586 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6587 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6588 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6589 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006591 Supported in default-server: No
6592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593check
6594 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6595 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6596 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6597 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6598 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6599 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6600 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6601 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6602 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006603 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6604 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006606 Supported in default-server: No
6607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006608cookie <value>
6609 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6610 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6611 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6612 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6613 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6614 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6615 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006617 Supported in default-server: No
6618
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006619disabled
6620 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6621 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6622 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6623 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6624 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6625
6626 Supported in default-server: No
6627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006628error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006629 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6630 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6631 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006633 Supported in default-server: Yes
6634
6635 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006637fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006638 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6639 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6640 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006642 Supported in default-server: Yes
6643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006644id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006645 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6646 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6647 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006649 Supported in default-server: No
6650
6651inter <delay>
6652fastinter <delay>
6653downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006654 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6655 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6656 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6657 between checks depending on the server state :
6658
6659 Server state | Interval used
6660 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6661 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6662 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6663 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6664 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6665 or yet unchecked. |
6666 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6667 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6668 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006670 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6671 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6672 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6673 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6674 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6675 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6676 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6677 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6678 servers.
6679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006680 Supported in default-server: Yes
6681
6682maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006683 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6684 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6685 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6686 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6687 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6688 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6689 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6690 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006692 Supported in default-server: Yes
6693
6694maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006695 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6696 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6697 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6698 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6699 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6700 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6701 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006703 Supported in default-server: Yes
6704
6705minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006706 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6707 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6708 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6709 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6710 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6711 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006712 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006713 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006715 Supported in default-server: Yes
6716
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006717non-stick
6718 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6719 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6720 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006722observe <mode>
6723 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6724 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6725 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6726 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6727 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6728 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6729 headers, a timeout, etc.
6730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006731 Supported in default-server: No
6732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006733 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006735on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006736 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6737 Currently, four modes are available:
6738 - fastinter: force fastinter
6739 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6740 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6741 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6742 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006744 Supported in default-server: Yes
6745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006746 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6747
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006748on-marked-down <action>
6749 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6750 Currently one action is available:
6751 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6752
6753 Actions are disabled by default
6754
6755 Supported in default-server: Yes
6756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006757port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006758 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6759 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6760 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6761 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6762 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6763 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006765 Supported in default-server: Yes
6766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006767redir <prefix>
6768 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6769 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6770 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6771 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6772 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6773 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6774 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6775 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006776 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006777 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6778 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6779 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6780 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6781 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6782
6783 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006785 Supported in default-server: No
6786
6787rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006788 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6789 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6790 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006792 Supported in default-server: Yes
6793
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006794send-proxy
6795 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6796 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6797 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6798 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6799 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6800 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6801 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6802 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6803 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6804 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6805 option of the "bind" keyword.
6806
6807 Supported in default-server: No
6808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006809slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006810 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6811 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6812 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6813 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6814 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6815 parameters :
6816
6817 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6818 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6819
6820 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6821 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6822 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6823 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6824
6825 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6826 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6827 seen as failed.
6828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006829 Supported in default-server: Yes
6830
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006831source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006832source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006833source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006834 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6835 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6836 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6837 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6838
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006839 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6840 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6841 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6842 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6843 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6844 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6845 server.
6846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006847 Supported in default-server: No
6848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006849track [<proxy>/]<server>
6850 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6851 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6852 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6853 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6854 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006856 Supported in default-server: No
6857
6858weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006859 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6860 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6861 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006862 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6863 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6864 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6865 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6866 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6867 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006869 Supported in default-server: Yes
6870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006871
68726. HTTP header manipulation
6873---------------------------
6874
6875In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6876response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6877request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6878which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6879against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6880to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6881passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6882headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6883never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6884
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006885There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6886(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6887rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6888messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6889in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006890happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006891add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6892normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006894This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6895in section 4.2 :
6896
6897 - reqadd <string>
6898 - reqallow <search>
6899 - reqiallow <search>
6900 - reqdel <search>
6901 - reqidel <search>
6902 - reqdeny <search>
6903 - reqideny <search>
6904 - reqpass <search>
6905 - reqipass <search>
6906 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6907 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6908 - reqtarpit <search>
6909 - reqitarpit <search>
6910 - rspadd <string>
6911 - rspdel <search>
6912 - rspidel <search>
6913 - rspdeny <search>
6914 - rspideny <search>
6915 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6916 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6917
6918With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6919is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6920parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6921prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6922Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6923
6924 \t for a tab
6925 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6926 \n for a new line (LF)
6927 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6928 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6929 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6930 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6931 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6932
6933The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6934portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6935above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6936regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
69379 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6938is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6939
6940The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6941after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6942
6943Notes related to these keywords :
6944---------------------------------
6945 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6946 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6947 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6948
6949 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6950 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6951 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6952
6953 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6954 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6955 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6956 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6957 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6958
6959 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6960 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6961 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6962 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6963 useless headers before adding new ones.
6964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006965 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006966 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6967
6968 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6969 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6970 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6971
6972 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6973 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006974 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006975
6976
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010069777. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6978------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006979
6980The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6981content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6982from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6983simple :
6984
6985 - define test criteria with sets of values
6986 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6987
6988The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6989
6990In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6991
6992 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6993
6994This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6995Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6996and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6997an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6998of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6999
7000ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7001'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7002which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7003
7004There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7005performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7006
7007The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7008
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007009 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7010 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007011 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7012
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007013The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7014specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7015possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007016multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7017be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7018needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7019space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7020match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7021lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7022duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7023to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7024instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007025
7026 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7027
7028In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7029the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7030case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7031too.
7032
7033Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7034a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7035ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007037Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007039 - integers or integer ranges
7040 - strings
7041 - regular expressions
7042 - IP addresses and networks
7043
7044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070457.1. Matching integers
7046----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007047
7048Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7049that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7050expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7051may be omitted.
7052
7053For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7054unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7055representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7056
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007057As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7058two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7059instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7060ranges and operators.
7061
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007062For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007063operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7064Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7065of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007067Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007068
7069 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7070 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7071 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7072 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7073 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007075For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007076
7077 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7078
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007079This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7080
7081 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070847.2. Matching strings
7085---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007086
7087String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7088exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7089characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7090string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7091to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007092before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007093
7094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070957.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7096-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007097
7098Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7099they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7100possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7101passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7102the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007103the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7104match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007105
7106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071077.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7108----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007109
7110IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7111netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7112within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007113host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007114difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7115at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7116does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7117parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007118
7119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071207.5. Available matching criteria
7121--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071237.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7124------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007125
7126A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7127analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7128addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007130always_false
7131 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7132 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7133
7134always_true
7135 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7136 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7137
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007138avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007139avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007140 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7141 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7142 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7143 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7144 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7145 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7146 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7147 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7148 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7149 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7150 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007151
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007152be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007153be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007154 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7155 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7156 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7157 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7158 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007159
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007160be_id <integer>
7161 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7162 backend it was called.
7163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007164be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007165be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007166 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7167 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7168 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7169 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7170 sucking of an online dictionary).
7171
7172 Example :
7173 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7174 backend dynamic
7175 mode http
7176 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7177 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007178
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007179connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007180connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007181 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007182 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007183 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7184
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007185 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7186 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007187
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007188 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007189 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7190 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7191 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7192 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7193 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007194 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007196 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7197 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7198 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7199 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007201dst <ip_address>
7202 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7203 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007204
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007205dst_conn <integer>
7206 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7207 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7208 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7209 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7210 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7211 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7212
7213dst_port <integer>
7214 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7215 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7216
7217fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007218fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007219 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7220 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7221 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7222 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7223 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7224 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7225 criteria.
7226
7227fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007228 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007229 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007230
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007231fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007232fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007233 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7234 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7235 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7236 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7237 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7238 the rate to go down below the limit.
7239
7240 Example :
7241 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7242 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7243 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7244 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7245 frontend mail
7246 bind :25
7247 mode tcp
7248 maxconn 100
7249 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7250 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7251 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7252 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007254nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007255nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007256 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7257 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7258 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7259 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7260 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007262queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007263queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007264 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7265 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7266 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7267 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7268 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7269 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7270 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007272sc1_bytes_in_rate
7273sc2_bytes_in_rate
7274 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7275 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7276 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7277
7278sc1_bytes_out_rate
7279sc2_bytes_out_rate
7280 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7281 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7282 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7283
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007284sc1_clr_gpc0
7285sc2_clr_gpc0
7286 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7287 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7288 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7289 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7290 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7291 was verified :
7292
7293 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7294 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7295 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7296 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7297 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7298 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7299 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007301sc1_conn_cnt
7302sc2_conn_cnt
7303 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7304 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7305
7306sc1_conn_cur
7307sc2_conn_cur
7308 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7309 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7310 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7311
7312sc1_conn_rate
7313sc2_conn_rate
7314 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7315 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7316 See also src_conn_rate.
7317
7318sc1_get_gpc0
7319sc2_get_gpc0
7320 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7321 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7322
7323sc1_http_err_cnt
7324sc2_http_err_cnt
7325 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7326 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7327 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7328
7329sc1_http_err_rate
7330sc2_http_err_rate
7331 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7332 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7333 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7334 src_http_err_rate.
7335
7336sc1_http_req_cnt
7337sc2_http_req_cnt
7338 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7339 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7340 src_http_req_cnt.
7341
7342sc1_http_req_rate
7343sc2_http_req_rate
7344 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7345 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7346 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7347 src_http_req_rate.
7348
7349sc1_inc_gpc0
7350sc2_inc_gpc0
7351 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7352 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7353 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7354 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7355 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7356 when a first ACL was verified :
7357
7358 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7359 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7360 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7361
7362sc1_kbytes_in
7363sc2_kbytes_in
7364 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7365 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7366 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7367 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7368
7369sc1_kbytes_out
7370sc2_kbytes_out
7371 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7372 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7373 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7374 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7375
7376sc1_sess_cnt
7377sc2_sess_cnt
7378 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7379 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7380 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7381 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7382 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7383 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7384
7385sc1_sess_rate
7386sc2_sess_rate
7387 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7388 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7389 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7390 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7391 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7392 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7393
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007394so_id <integer>
7395 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7396
7397src <ip_address>
7398 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7399 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7400 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7401
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007402src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007403src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007404 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7405 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7406 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007407 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007408
7409src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007410src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007411 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7412 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7413 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007415
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007416src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7417src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7418 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7419 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7420 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7421 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7422 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7423 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7424
7425 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7426 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7427 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7428 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7429 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7430 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7431 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7432
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007433src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007434src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007435 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7436 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7437 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007438 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007439
7440src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007441src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007442 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7443 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7444 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007445 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007446
7447src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007448src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007449 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7450 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7451 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007452 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007453
7454src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007455src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007456 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7457 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7458 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007460
7461src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007462src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007463 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7464 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7465 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007466 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007467
7468src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007469src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007470 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7471 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7472 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7473 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007474 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007475
7476src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007477src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007478 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7479 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7480 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007482
7483src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007484src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007485 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7486 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7487 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7488 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007489 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007490
7491src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007492src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007493 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7494 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7495 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7496 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7497 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7498 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7499
7500 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7501 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007502 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007503
7504src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007505src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007506 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7507 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7508 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7509 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007510 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007511
7512src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007513src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007514 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7515 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7516 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7517 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007519
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007520src_port <integer>
7521 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007522
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007523src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007524src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007525 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7526 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7527 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7528 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007529 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007530
7531src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007532src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007533 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7534 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7535 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7536 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007537 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007538
7539src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007540src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007541 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007542 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7543 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007544 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7545 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7546 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007547 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007548
7549 Example :
7550 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7551 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7552 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7553 listen ssh
7554 bind :22
7555 mode tcp
7556 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007557 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007558 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7559 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7560
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007561srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007562 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7563 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7564 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7565 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7566
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007567srv_id <integer>
7568 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7569
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007570srv_is_up(<server>)
7571srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7572 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7573 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7574 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7575 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7576 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7577 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7578 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7579 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7580
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007581table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007582table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007583 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7585
7586table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007587table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007588 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7589 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7590 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020075937.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7594---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007595
7596A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7597during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007598through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7599keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007600
7601req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007602 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007603 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7604 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7605 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7606 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7607 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7608 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7609
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007610req_proto_http
7611 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7612 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007613 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007614 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7615 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7616
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007617req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007618req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007619 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7620 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7621 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7622 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7623 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7624 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7625 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7626 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7627
7628req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007629req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007630 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7631 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7632 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7633 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7634 cookies.
7635
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007636req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7637 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7638 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7639 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7640 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7641 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7642 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7643 with TCP request content inspection.
7644
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007645req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7646 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7647 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7648 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7649 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7650
7651rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7652 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7653 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7654 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7655 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7656
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007657wait_end
7658 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7659 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7660 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7661 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7662 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7663 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7664 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7665 inspection.
7666
7667 Examples :
7668 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7669 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7670 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7671
7672 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7673 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7674 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7675 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7676 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7677 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7678 tcp-request content reject
7679
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076817.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7682--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007683
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007684A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007685application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7686read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7687than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7688
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007689hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007690hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007691 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7692 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7693 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7694 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7695 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7696
7697 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7698 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7699 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7700
7701 hdr(Connection) -i close
7702
7703hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007704hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007705 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7706 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7707 response headers sent by the server.
7708
7709hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007710hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007711 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7712 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7713 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7714 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7715 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7716 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7717 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7718
7719hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007720hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007721 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7722 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7723 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7724 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7725 headers sent by the server.
7726
7727hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007728hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007729 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7730 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7731 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7732 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7733 server.
7734
7735hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007736hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7738 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7739 response headers sent by the server.
7740
7741hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007742hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7744 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7745 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7746 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7747
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007748hdr_len <integer>
7749hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7750 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7751 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7752 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7753 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7754
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007755hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007756hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007757 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7758 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7759 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7760 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7761 response headers sent by the server.
7762
7763hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007764hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007765 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7766 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7767 response headers sent by the server.
7768
7769hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007770hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007771 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7772 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7773 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7774 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7775
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007776http_auth(<userlist>)
7777http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007778 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7779 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7780 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7781 of specified groups.
7782
7783 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7784
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02007785http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007786 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7787 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7788 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7789 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007791method <string>
7792 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7793 already check for most common methods.
7794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007795path <string>
7796 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7797 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7798 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7799
7800path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007801 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7802 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007804path_dir <string>
7805 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7806 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7807 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7808 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7809
7810path_dom <string>
7811 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7812 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7813 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007815path_end <string>
7816 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7817 control file name extension.
7818
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007819path_len <integer>
7820 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
7821 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007823path_reg <regex>
7824 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7825 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7826 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7827
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007828path_sub <string>
7829 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7830 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7831 "path_dir".
7832
7833req_ver <string>
7834 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7835 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7836
7837status <integer>
7838 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7839 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7840 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007842url <string>
7843 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7844 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7845
7846url_beg <string>
7847 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7848 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007850url_dir <string>
7851 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7852 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7853 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7854 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7855
7856url_dom <string>
7857 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7858 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7859 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7860
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007861url_end <string>
7862 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7863 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007864
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007865url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007866 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7867 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007868 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007869
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007870url_len <integer>
7871 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
7872 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7873
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007874url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007875 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7876 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007877 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007878 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007879
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007880url_reg <regex>
7881 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7882 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7883 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007885url_sub <string>
7886 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7887 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007888
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078907.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7891---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007893Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7894every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007895order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007897ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7898---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007899FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007900HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007901HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7902HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007903HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7904HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7905HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7906HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7907LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007908METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7909METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7910METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7911METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7912METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7913METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007914RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007915REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007916TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007917WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7918---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007919
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079217.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7922----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007924Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7925combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007927 - AND (implicit)
7928 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7929 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007931A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007933 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007935Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7936indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007938For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7939"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7940requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7941is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007943 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7944 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7945 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7946 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007948To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7949and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007951 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7952 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7953 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7954 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007956 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7957 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7958 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7959 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007960
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007961It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7962expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7963be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7964the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7965
7966 The following rule :
7967
7968 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7969 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7970
7971 Can also be written that way :
7972
7973 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7974
7975It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7976to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7977simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7978sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7979good use is the following :
7980
7981 With named ACLs :
7982
7983 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7984 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7985 monitor fail if site_dead
7986
7987 With anonymous ACLs :
7988
7989 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007991See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007992
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007993
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079947.8. Pattern extraction
7995-----------------------
7996
7997The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7998response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7999for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8000
8001All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8002"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8003begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8004arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8005much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8006equivalent used in ACLs.
8007
8008The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8009
8010 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008011 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8012 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8013 according to RFC 4291.
8014
8015 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8016 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008017
8018 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8019 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8020 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008021 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8022 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8023 according to RFC 4291.
8024
8025 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8026 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8027 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008028 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008029
8030 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8031 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8032 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8033 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8034 type integer and only works with such tables.
8035
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008036 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008037 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
8038 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
8039 x-forwarded-for header.
8040
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008041 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008042 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8043 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8044 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8045 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008046
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008047 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008048 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8049 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8050 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8051 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8052 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8053 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8054 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8055 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8056
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008057 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008058 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008059 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008060 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8061 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8062 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8063
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008064 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008065 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8066 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8067 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8068 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8069
8070 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8071 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8072 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8073 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8074 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8075 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8076 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8077
8078 Example :
8079 listen tse-farm
8080 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8081 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8082 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8083 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8084 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8085 persist rdp-cookie
8086 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8087 # This is only useful makes sense if
8088 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8089 stick-table type string size 204800
8090 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8091 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8092 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8093
8094 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8095 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8096
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008097 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008098 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8099 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8100 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8101 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8102 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8103 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8104 restarts.
8105
8106 See also : "appsession"
8107
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008108 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008109 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8110 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8111 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8112 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8113 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8114
8115 See also : "appsession"
8116
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008117
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008118The currently available list of transformations include :
8119
8120 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8121 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8122 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8123
8124 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8125 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8126 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8127
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008128 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008129 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8130 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8131 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8132 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081358. Logging
8136----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008137
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008138One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8139provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8140very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8141provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8142state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008143to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008144headers.
8145
8146In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8147about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8148send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8149
8150 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8151 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8152 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8153 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8154 at the termination.
8155
8156The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8157allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8158as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8159while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8160real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8161delay.
8162
8163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081648.1. Log levels
8165---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008166
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008167TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008168source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008169HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8170in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8171track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8172syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8173about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008174
8175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081768.2. Log formats
8177----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008178
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008179HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008180and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8181slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8182options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008183
8184 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8185 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8186 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8187 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8188 extents.
8189
8190 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8191 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8192 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8193 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8194 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8195
8196 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8197 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8198 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8199 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8200 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8201
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008202 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8203 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8204 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8205 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008207Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8208specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8209field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8210servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8211always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8212identifier.
8213
8214Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8215 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8216 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8217 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8218 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8219
8220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082218.2.1. Default log format
8222-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008223
8224This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8225as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8226format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8227
8228 Example :
8229 listen www
8230 mode http
8231 log global
8232 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8233
8234 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8235 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8236 (www/HTTP)
8237
8238 Field Format Extract from the example above
8239 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8240 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8241 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8242 4 'to' to
8243 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8244 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8245
8246Detailed fields description :
8247 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8248 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8249 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8250 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8251 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8252 and processed the connection.
8253 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8254
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008255In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8256"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8257connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008259It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8260will eventually disappear.
8261
8262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082638.2.2. TCP log format
8264---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008265
8266The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8267is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8268information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8269counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8270emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8271environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8272the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8273sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008274specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8275not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8276fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8277marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008278
8279 Example :
8280 frontend fnt
8281 mode tcp
8282 option tcplog
8283 log global
8284 default_backend bck
8285
8286 backend bck
8287 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8288
8289 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8290 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8291 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8292
8293 Field Format Extract from the example above
8294 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8295 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8296 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8297 4 frontend_name fnt
8298 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8299 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8300 7 bytes_read* 212
8301 8 termination_state --
8302 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8303 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8304
8305Detailed fields description :
8306 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008307 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8308 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8309 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8310 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8311 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008312
8313 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008314 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8315 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8316 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008317
8318 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8319 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8320 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8321 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8322
8323 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8324 and processed the connection.
8325
8326 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8327 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8328 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8329 applications.
8330
8331 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8332 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8333 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8334 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8335 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8336
8337 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8338 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8339 See "Timers" below for more details.
8340
8341 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8342 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8343 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8344 "Timers" below for more details.
8345
8346 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8347 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8348 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8349 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8350 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8351 details.
8352
8353 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8354 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8355 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8356 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8357 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8358
8359 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8360 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8361 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8362 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8363 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8364 for more details.
8365
8366 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8367 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8368 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8369 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8370 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008371 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008372
8373 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8374 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8375 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8376 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8377 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8378 caused by a denial of service attack.
8379
8380 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8381 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8382 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8383 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8384 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8385 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8386 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8387 denial of service attack.
8388
8389 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8390 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8391 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8392 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8393 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8394 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8395 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8396 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8397 be processed than on other servers.
8398
8399 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8400 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8401 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8402 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8403 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8404 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8405 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8406 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8407 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8408 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8409 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8410 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8411 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8412
8413 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8414 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8415 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8416 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8417 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8418 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8419 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8420 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8421
8422 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8423 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8424 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8425 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8426 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8427 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8428 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8429 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8430 occurs.
8431
8432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084338.2.3. HTTP log format
8434----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008435
8436The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8437is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8438the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8439are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8440emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8441generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8442"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8443which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008444frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8445is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008446
8447Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8448slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8449with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8450
8451 Example :
8452 frontend http-in
8453 mode http
8454 option httplog
8455 log global
8456 default_backend bck
8457
8458 backend static
8459 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8460
8461 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8462 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8463 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008464 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008465
8466 Field Format Extract from the example above
8467 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8468 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8469 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8470 4 frontend_name http-in
8471 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8472 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8473 7 status_code 200
8474 8 bytes_read* 2750
8475 9 captured_request_cookie -
8476 10 captured_response_cookie -
8477 11 termination_state ----
8478 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8479 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8480 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8481 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8482 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008483
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008484
8485Detailed fields description :
8486 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008487 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8488 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8489 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8490 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8491 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008492
8493 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008494 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8495 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8496 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008497
8498 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8499 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8500 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8501 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8502 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8503
8504 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8505 and processed the connection.
8506
8507 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8508 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8509 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8510
8511 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8512 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8513 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8514 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8515 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8516 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8517
8518 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8519 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8520 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8521 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8522 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8523 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8524
8525 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8526 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8527 See "Timers" below for more details.
8528
8529 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8530 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8531 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8532 below for more details.
8533
8534 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8535 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8536 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8537 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8538 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8539 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8540 for more details.
8541
8542 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8543 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8544 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8545 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8546 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8547 details.
8548
8549 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8550 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8551 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8552
8553 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8554 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8555 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8556 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8557 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8558 overflowing.
8559
8560 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8561 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8562 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8563 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8564 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8565 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8566 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8567 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8568
8569 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8570 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8571 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8572 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8573 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8574 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8575 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8576 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8577
8578 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8579 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8580 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8581 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8582 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8583 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8584 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8585
8586 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8587 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8588 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8589 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8590 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008591 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008592 system.
8593
8594 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8595 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8596 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8597 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8598 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8599 caused by a denial of service attack.
8600
8601 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8602 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8603 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8604 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8605 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8606 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8607 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8608 denial of service attack.
8609
8610 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8611 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8612 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8613 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8614 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8615 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8616 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8617 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8618 processed than on other servers.
8619
8620 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8621 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8622 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8623 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8624 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8625 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8626 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8627 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8628 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8629 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8630 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8631 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8632 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8633
8634 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8635 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8636 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8637 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8638 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8639 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8640 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8641 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8642
8643 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8644 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8645 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8646 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8647 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8648 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8649 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8650 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8651 occurs.
8652
8653 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8654 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8655 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8656 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8657 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8658 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8659 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8660 cookies" below for more details.
8661
8662 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8663 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8664 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8665 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8666 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8667 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8668 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8669 and cookies" below for more details.
8670
8671 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8672 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8673 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8674 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8675 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8676 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8677 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8678 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8679
8680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086818.3. Advanced logging options
8682-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008683
8684Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8685just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8686options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8687for more information about their usage.
8688
8689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8691------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008692
8693It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8694haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8695commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8696monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8697ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8698
8699 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8700 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8701 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8702 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8703
8704 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8705 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8706 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8707 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8708 such as other load-balancers.
8709
8710 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8711 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8712 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8713
8714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8716----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008717
8718The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8719what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8720or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8721"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8722just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8723log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8724after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8725is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8726with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8727with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8728
8729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8731------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008732
8733Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8734for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8735"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8736retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8737raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8738a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8739file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8740you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8741"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8742
8743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8745--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008746
8747Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8748multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8749them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8750"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8751logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8752error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8753and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8754too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8755useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8756alternative.
8757
8758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087598.4. Timing events
8760------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008761
8762Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8763reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8764the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8765frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8766mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8767
8768 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8769 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8770 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8771 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8772 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8773
8774 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8775 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8776 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8777 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8778 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8779
8780 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8781 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8782 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8783 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8784 connection never established.
8785
8786 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8787 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8788 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8789 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8790 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8791 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8792 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8793 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8794 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8795 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8796 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8797
8798 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8799 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8800 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8801 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8802 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8803
8804 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8805
8806 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8807 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8808 negative.
8809
8810These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8811protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8812that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008813due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008814close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8815session has been aborted on timeout.
8816
8817Most common cases :
8818
8819 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8820 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8821 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8822 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8823 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8824 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8825 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8826 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8827 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008828 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8829 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8830 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008831
8832 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8833 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8834 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8835 of ms on remote networks.
8836
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008837 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8838 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8839 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008840
8841 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8842 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8843 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8844 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8845 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8846 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8847 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8848 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8849 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8850 to the server until another one is released.
8851
8852Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8853
8854 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8855 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8856 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8857
8858 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8859 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8860 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8861
8862 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8863 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8864 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8865 flags.
8866
8867 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8868 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8869 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8870 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8871 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8872 the client connection was maintained open.
8873
8874 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8875 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8876 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8877 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8878
8879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088808.5. Session state at disconnection
8881-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008882
8883TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8884"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
88852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8886each of which has a special meaning :
8887
8888 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8889 session to terminate :
8890
8891 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8892
8893 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8894 server explicitly refused it.
8895
8896 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8897 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8898 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8899 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8900 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8901 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8902
8903 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8904 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8905 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8906 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8907 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8908
8909 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8910 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8911 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8912 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8913 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8914
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09008915 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
8916 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
8917
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02008918 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
8919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008920 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8921 send or receive data.
8922
8923 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8924 send or receive data.
8925
8926 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8927 with nothing left in the buffers.
8928
8929 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8930
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008931 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008932 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8933
8934 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8935 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8936 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8937 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8938 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8939
8940 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8941 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8942
8943 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8944 server (HTTP only).
8945
8946 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8947
8948 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8949 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8950 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8951
8952 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8953 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8954 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8955
8956 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8957
8958 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8959 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8960
8961 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8962 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8963 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8964
8965 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8966 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008967 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8968 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008969
8970 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8971 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8972 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8973 another server.
8974
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008975 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008976 server.
8977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008978 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8979 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8980 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8981 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8982
8983 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8984 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8985 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8986 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008988 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8989
8990 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8991 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8992
8993 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8994
8995 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8996 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8997 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8998
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008999 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9000 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9001 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9002 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9003 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9004
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009005 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9006
9007 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9008 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9009
9010 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9011
9012 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9013
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009014The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9015was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009016helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9017starvation, attacks, etc...
9018
9019The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9020alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9021easier finding and understanding.
9022
9023 Flags Reason
9024
9025 -- Normal termination.
9026
9027 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9028 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9029 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9030 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9031
9032 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9033 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9034 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9035 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9036 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9037 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009039 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9040 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9041 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9042
9043 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9044 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9045 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9046
9047 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9048 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9049 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9050 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9051 the server takes too long to respond.
9052
9053 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9054 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9055 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9056 long a time to respond.
9057
9058 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9059 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9060 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9061 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9062 and the client.
9063
9064 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9065 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9066 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9067 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9068 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9069 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9070
9071 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9072 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009073 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9074 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9075 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9076 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009078 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009079 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9080 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9081 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9082 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9083 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9084
9085 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9086 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9087 503 or 504 here.
9088
9089 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9090 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9091 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9092 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9093 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9094
9095 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9096 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009097 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009098 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9099 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9100
9101 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9102 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9103 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9104 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9105 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9106 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9107 between haproxy and the server.
9108
9109 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9110 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9111 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9112 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9113 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9114 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9115 solution is to fix the application.
9116
9117 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9118 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9119 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9120 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9121 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9122 external attacks.
9123
9124 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9125 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9126 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9127 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9128 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9129
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009130 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9131 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9132 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9133 the client.
9134
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009135 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9136 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9137 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9138 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009139 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9140 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9141 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9142 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9143 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009144
9145 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9146 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9147 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9148 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9149
9150 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9151 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9152 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9153 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9154
9155 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9156 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9157 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9158 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9159
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009160The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9161persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9162important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9163re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9164
9165 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9166
9167 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9168 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9169 set on a GET request.
9170
9171 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9172 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9173 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9174 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9175
9176 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9177 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9178 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9179
9180 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9181 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9182 already got a cookie.
9183
9184 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9185 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9186 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9187 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9188 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9189
9190 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9191 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9192 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9193
9194 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9195 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9196 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9197
9198 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9199 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9200
9201 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9202 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9203 then advertised in the response.
9204
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092068.6. Non-printable characters
9207-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009208
9209In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9210consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9211converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9212prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9213being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9214escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9215is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9216'}' when logging headers.
9217
9218Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9219issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9220containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9221
9222Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9223the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9224performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9225
9226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9228---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009229
9230Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9231achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009232section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009233cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9234the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9235the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009236locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009237not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9238user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9239a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9240wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9241
9242 Examples :
9243 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9244 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9245
9246 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9247 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9248
9249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9251---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009252
9253Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9254proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9255the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9256server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9257
9258Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9259response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009260section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009261
9262It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009263time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9264appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009265are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9266and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9267follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9268request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9269in the logs.
9270
9271 Example :
9272 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9273 listen proxy-out
9274 mode http
9275 option httplog
9276 option logasap
9277 log global
9278 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9279
9280 # log the name of the virtual server
9281 capture request header Host len 20
9282
9283 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9284 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9285
9286 # log the beginning of the referrer
9287 capture request header Referer len 20
9288
9289 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9290 capture response header Server len 20
9291
9292 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9293 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9294
9295 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9296 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9297
9298 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9299 capture response header Via len 20
9300
9301 # log the URL location during a redirection
9302 capture response header Location len 20
9303
9304 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9305 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9306 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9307 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9308 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9309
9310 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9311 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9312 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9313 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009314 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009315
9316 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9317 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9318 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9319 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9320 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009321 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009322
9323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093248.9. Examples of logs
9325---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009326
9327These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9328them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9329reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9330
9331 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9332 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9333 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9334
9335 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9336 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9337
9338 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9339 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9340 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9341
9342 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9343 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9344
9345 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9346 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9347 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9348
9349 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009350 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009351 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9352 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9353
9354 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9355 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9356 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9357
9358 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9359 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009360 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009361 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9362 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9363 to return the 502 and not the server.
9364
9365 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009366 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009367
9368 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9369 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9370 Nothing was sent to any server.
9371
9372 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9373 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9374
9375 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9376 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9377 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9378 send a 408 return code to the client.
9379
9380 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9381 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9382
9383 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9384 5 seconds ("c----").
9385
9386 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9387 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009388 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009389
9390 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009391 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009392 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9393 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9394 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9395 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9396 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009397
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093999. Statistics and monitoring
9400----------------------------
9401
9402It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9403mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9404CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9405Unix socket.
9406
9407
94089.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009409---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009410
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009411The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9412page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009414 0. pxname: proxy name
9415 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9416 for server)
9417 2. qcur: current queued requests
9418 3. qmax: max queued requests
9419 4. scur: current sessions
9420 5. smax: max sessions
9421 6. slim: sessions limit
9422 7. stot: total sessions
9423 8. bin: bytes in
9424 9. bout: bytes out
9425 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009426 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009427 12. ereq: request errors
9428 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009429 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009430 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9431 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009432 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009433 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9434 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9435 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9436 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9437 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9438 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9439 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9440 25. qlimit: queue limit
9441 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9442 27. iid: unique proxy id
9443 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9444 29. throttle: warm up status
9445 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9446 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009447 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009448 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9449 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9450 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009451 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009452 UNK -> unknown
9453 INI -> initializing
9454 SOCKERR -> socket error
9455 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9456 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9457 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9458 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9459 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9460 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9461 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9462 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9463 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9464 disable-on-404
9465 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9466 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9467 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009468 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9469 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009470 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9471 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9472 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9473 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9474 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9475 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009476 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9477 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9478 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9479 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009480 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9481 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009482
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094849.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009485-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009486
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009487The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009488must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9489is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9490a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9491risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9492followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9493given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9494then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9495to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009496
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009497It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9498on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9499own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009501clear counters
9502 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9503 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9504 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9505 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9506 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9507
9508clear counters all
9509 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9510 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9511 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9512
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009513clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9514 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9515
9516 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9517 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9518 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9519 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9520 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9521 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9522
9523 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9524
9525 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9526 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9527 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9528 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9529 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9530 the ACLs :
9531
9532 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9533 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9534 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9535 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9536 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9537 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9538
9539 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009540 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9541 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009542
9543 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009544 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009545 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009546 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9547 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9548 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9549 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009550
9551 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9552
9553 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009554 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009555 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9556 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009557 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9558 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9559 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009560
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009561disable frontend <frontend>
9562 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9563 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9564 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9565 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9566 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9567 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9568 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9569 on the stats page.
9570
9571 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9572 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9573
9574 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9575 level "admin".
9576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009577disable server <backend>/<server>
9578 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9579 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9580 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9581 during the maintenance.
9582
9583 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9584 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9585
9586 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009587 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009588
9589 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9590 level "admin".
9591
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009592enable frontend <frontend>
9593 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9594 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9595 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9596 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9597 which was disabled.
9598
9599 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9600 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9601
9602 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9603 level "admin".
9604
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009605enable server <backend>/<server>
9606 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9607 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9608
9609 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009610 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009611
9612 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9613 level "admin".
9614
9615get weight <backend>/<server>
9616 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9617 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9618 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9619 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9620 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009621 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009622
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009623help
9624 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9625 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009626
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009627prompt
9628 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9629 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9630 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9631 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9632 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9633 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9634 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9635 command.
9636
9637quit
9638 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009639
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009640set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9641 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9642 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9643 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9644 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9645 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9646 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9647 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9648
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009649set maxconn global <maxconn>
9650 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9651 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9652 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9653 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9654 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9655 setting.
9656
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009657set rate-limit connections global <value>
9658 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9659 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9660 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
9661 is passed in number of connections per second.
9662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009663set timeout cli <delay>
9664 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9665 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9666 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9667
9668set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9669 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9670 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9671 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9672 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9673 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9674 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9675 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9676 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9677 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9678 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9679 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9680 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9681 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009682 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009683
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009684show errors [<iid>]
9685 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9686 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009687 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9688 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9689 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009690
9691 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9692 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9693 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9694 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9695 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9696 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9697 are reported too.
9698
9699 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9700 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9701 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9702 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9703 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9704 code.
9705
9706 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9707 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9708 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9709 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9710 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9711 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9712 line.
9713
9714 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009715 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9716 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009717 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9718 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9719
9720 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9721 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9722 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9723 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9724 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9725 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9726 00204+ minal\r\n
9727 00211 \r\n
9728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009729 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009730 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9731 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9732 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9733 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9734 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9735 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009736
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009737show info
9738 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9739
9740show sess
9741 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009742 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9743 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9744
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009745show sess <id>
9746 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9747 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9748 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9749 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9750 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9751 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009752
9753show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9754 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9755 possible to dump only selected items :
9756 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9757 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9758 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9759 for example:
9760 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9761 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9762 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9763
9764 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009765 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9766 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009767 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9768 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9769 Nbproc: 1
9770 Process_num: 1
9771 (...)
9772
9773 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9774 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9775 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9776 (...)
9777 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9778
9779 $
9780
9781 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9782 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9783 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9784 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009785 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009786
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009787show table
9788 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9789 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9790 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9791 entries currently in use.
9792
9793 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009794 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009795 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
9796 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009797
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009798show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009799 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9800 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9801 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009802 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9803
9804 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9805 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9806 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9807 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9808 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9809
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009810 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9811 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9812 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9813 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9814 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9815 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9816
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009817
9818 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009819 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9820 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009821
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009822 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009823 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009824 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009825 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9826 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9827 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9828 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009829
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009830 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009831 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009832 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9833 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009834
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009835 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9836 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009837 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009838 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9839 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009840
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009841 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9842 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009843 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009844 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9845 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9846
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009847 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9848 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9849 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9850 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9851 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9852
9853 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9854 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9855 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009856 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9857 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009858 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9859 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009860
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009861shutdown frontend <frontend>
9862 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
9863 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
9864 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
9865 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
9866 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
9867 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
9868 once it is terminated.
9869
9870 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9871 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9872
9873 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9874 level "admin".
9875
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +02009876shutdown session <id>
9877 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
9878 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9879 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
9880 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
9881 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
9882 flag in the logs.
9883
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +02009884shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
9885 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
9886 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
9887 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
9888 'K' flag in the logs.
9889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009890/*
9891 * Local variables:
9892 * fill-column: 79
9893 * End:
9894 */